// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT. package medialive import ( "fmt" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/restjson" ) const opBatchUpdateSchedule = "BatchUpdateSchedule" // BatchUpdateScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the BatchUpdateSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See BatchUpdateSchedule for more information on using the BatchUpdateSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the BatchUpdateScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/BatchUpdateSchedule func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opBatchUpdateSchedule, HTTPMethod: "PUT", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/schedule", } if input == nil { input = &BatchUpdateScheduleInput{} } output = &BatchUpdateScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // BatchUpdateSchedule API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Update a channel schedule // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation BatchUpdateSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/BatchUpdateSchedule func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateSchedule(input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) (*BatchUpdateScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // BatchUpdateScheduleWithContext is the same as BatchUpdateSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See BatchUpdateSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchUpdateScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateChannel = "CreateChannel" // CreateChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateChannel for more information on using the CreateChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateChannel func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannelRequest(input *CreateChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateChannel, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels", } if input == nil { input = &CreateChannelInput{} } output = &CreateChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Creates a new channel // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation CreateChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateChannel func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannel(input *CreateChannelInput) (*CreateChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateChannelWithContext is the same as CreateChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateInput = "CreateInput" // CreateInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateInput operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateInput for more information on using the CreateInput // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateInputRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateInputRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInput func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputRequest(input *CreateInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateInputOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateInput, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs", } if input == nil { input = &CreateInputInput{} } output = &CreateInputOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Create an input // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation CreateInput for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInput func (c *MediaLive) CreateInput(input *CreateInputInput) (*CreateInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInputRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateInputWithContext is the same as CreateInput with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateInput for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInputRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateInputSecurityGroup = "CreateInputSecurityGroup" // CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateInputSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateInputSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups", } if input == nil { input = &CreateInputSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Creates a Input Security Group // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation CreateInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroup(input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateInputSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteChannel = "DeleteChannel" // DeleteChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteChannel for more information on using the DeleteChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteChannel func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannelRequest(input *DeleteChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteChannel, HTTPMethod: "DELETE", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteChannelInput{} } output = &DeleteChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DeleteChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Starts deletion of channel. The associated outputs are also deleted. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DeleteChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteChannel func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannel(input *DeleteChannelInput) (*DeleteChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteChannelWithContext is the same as DeleteChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteInput = "DeleteInput" // DeleteInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteInput operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteInput for more information on using the DeleteInput // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteInputRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteInputRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInput func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputRequest(input *DeleteInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteInputOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteInput, HTTPMethod: "DELETE", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteInputInput{} } output = &DeleteInputOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restjson.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Deletes the input end point // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DeleteInput for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInput func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInput(input *DeleteInputInput) (*DeleteInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInputRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteInputWithContext is the same as DeleteInput with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteInput for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInputRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteInputSecurityGroup = "DeleteInputSecurityGroup" // DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteInputSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteInputSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "DELETE", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restjson.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Deletes an Input Security Group // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DeleteInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroup(input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteInputSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteReservation = "DeleteReservation" // DeleteReservationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteReservation operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteReservation for more information on using the DeleteReservation // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteReservationRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteReservationRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteReservation func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservationRequest(input *DeleteReservationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteReservationOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteReservation, HTTPMethod: "DELETE", HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations/{reservationId}", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteReservationInput{} } output = &DeleteReservationOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DeleteReservation API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Delete an expired reservation. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DeleteReservation for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteReservation func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservation(input *DeleteReservationInput) (*DeleteReservationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteReservationRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteReservationWithContext is the same as DeleteReservation with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteReservation for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteReservationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteReservationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteReservationRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeChannel = "DescribeChannel" // DescribeChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeChannel for more information on using the DescribeChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeChannel func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannelRequest(input *DescribeChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeChannel, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeChannelInput{} } output = &DescribeChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Gets details about a channel // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeChannel func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannel(input *DescribeChannelInput) (*DescribeChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeChannelWithContext is the same as DescribeChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeInput = "DescribeInput" // DescribeInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeInput operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeInput for more information on using the DescribeInput // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeInputRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeInputRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInput func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputRequest(input *DescribeInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeInputOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeInput, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeInputInput{} } output = &DescribeInputOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Produces details about an input // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeInput for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInput func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInput(input *DescribeInputInput) (*DescribeInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeInputRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeInputWithContext is the same as DescribeInput with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeInput for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeInputRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeInputSecurityGroup = "DescribeInputSecurityGroup" // DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the DescribeInputSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeInputSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Produces a summary of an Input Security Group // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroup(input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) (*DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DescribeInputSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeOffering = "DescribeOffering" // DescribeOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeOffering operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeOffering for more information on using the DescribeOffering // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeOfferingRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeOfferingRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeOffering func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOfferingRequest(input *DescribeOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOfferingOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeOffering, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings/{offeringId}", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeOfferingInput{} } output = &DescribeOfferingOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeOffering API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Get details for an offering. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeOffering for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeOffering func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOffering(input *DescribeOfferingInput) (*DescribeOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeOfferingRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeOfferingWithContext is the same as DescribeOffering with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeOffering for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeOfferingRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeReservation = "DescribeReservation" // DescribeReservationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeReservation operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeReservation for more information on using the DescribeReservation // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservationRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeReservationRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeReservation func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservationRequest(input *DescribeReservationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservationOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeReservation, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations/{reservationId}", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeReservationInput{} } output = &DescribeReservationOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeReservation API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Get details for a reservation. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeReservation for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeReservation func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservation(input *DescribeReservationInput) (*DescribeReservationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservationRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeReservationWithContext is the same as DescribeReservation with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeReservation for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservationRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeSchedule = "DescribeSchedule" // DescribeScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeSchedule for more information on using the DescribeSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeSchedule func (c *MediaLive) DescribeScheduleRequest(input *DescribeScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeSchedule, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/schedule", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeScheduleInput{} } output = &DescribeScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeSchedule API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Get a channel schedule // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation DescribeSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeSchedule func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedule(input *DescribeScheduleInput) (*DescribeScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeScheduleWithContext is the same as DescribeSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeSchedulePages iterates over the pages of a DescribeSchedule operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeSchedule method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeSchedule operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeSchedulePages(params, // func(page *DescribeScheduleOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedulePages(input *DescribeScheduleInput, fn func(*DescribeScheduleOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext same as DescribeSchedulePages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeScheduleInput, fn func(*DescribeScheduleOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeScheduleInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeScheduleOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListChannels = "ListChannels" // ListChannelsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListChannels operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListChannels for more information on using the ListChannels // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListChannelsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListChannelsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListChannels func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsRequest(input *ListChannelsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListChannelsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListChannels, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListChannelsInput{} } output = &ListChannelsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListChannels API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Produces list of channels that have been created // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation ListChannels for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListChannels func (c *MediaLive) ListChannels(input *ListChannelsInput) (*ListChannelsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListChannelsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListChannelsWithContext is the same as ListChannels with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListChannels for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListChannelsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListChannelsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListChannelsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListChannelsPages iterates over the pages of a ListChannels operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListChannels method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListChannels operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListChannelsPages(params, // func(page *ListChannelsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsPages(input *ListChannelsInput, fn func(*ListChannelsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListChannelsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListChannelsPagesWithContext same as ListChannelsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListChannelsInput, fn func(*ListChannelsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListChannelsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListChannelsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListChannelsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListInputSecurityGroups = "ListInputSecurityGroups" // ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListInputSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListInputSecurityGroups for more information on using the ListInputSecurityGroups // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputSecurityGroups func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListInputSecurityGroups, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListInputSecurityGroupsInput{} } output = &ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListInputSecurityGroups API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Produces a list of Input Security Groups for an account // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation ListInputSecurityGroups for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputSecurityGroups func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroups(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) (*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListInputSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as ListInputSecurityGroups with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListInputSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListInputSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a ListInputSecurityGroups operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListInputSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInputSecurityGroups operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListInputSecurityGroupsPages(params, // func(page *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsPages(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as ListInputSecurityGroupsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListInputs = "ListInputs" // ListInputsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListInputs operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListInputs for more information on using the ListInputs // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListInputsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListInputsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputs func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsRequest(input *ListInputsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInputsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListInputs, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListInputsInput{} } output = &ListInputsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListInputs API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Produces list of inputs that have been created // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation ListInputs for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputs func (c *MediaLive) ListInputs(input *ListInputsInput) (*ListInputsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInputsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListInputsWithContext is the same as ListInputs with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListInputs for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInputsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListInputsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListInputsPages iterates over the pages of a ListInputs operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListInputs method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInputs operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListInputsPages(params, // func(page *ListInputsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsPages(input *ListInputsInput, fn func(*ListInputsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListInputsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListInputsPagesWithContext same as ListInputsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputsInput, fn func(*ListInputsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListInputsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListInputsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInputsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListOfferings = "ListOfferings" // ListOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListOfferings operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListOfferings for more information on using the ListOfferings // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListOfferingsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListOfferingsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListOfferings func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsRequest(input *ListOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListOfferingsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListOfferings, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListOfferingsInput{} } output = &ListOfferingsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListOfferings API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // List offerings available for purchase. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation ListOfferings for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListOfferings func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferings(input *ListOfferingsInput) (*ListOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListOfferingsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListOfferingsWithContext is the same as ListOfferings with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListOfferings for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListOfferingsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a ListOfferings operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListOfferings operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListOfferingsPages(params, // func(page *ListOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsPages(input *ListOfferingsInput, fn func(*ListOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListOfferingsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListOfferingsPagesWithContext same as ListOfferingsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListOfferingsInput, fn func(*ListOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListOfferingsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListOfferingsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListOfferingsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opListReservations = "ListReservations" // ListReservationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ListReservations operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ListReservations for more information on using the ListReservations // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ListReservationsRequest method. // req, resp := client.ListReservationsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListReservations func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsRequest(input *ListReservationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListReservationsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opListReservations, HTTPMethod: "GET", HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"}, LimitToken: "MaxResults", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &ListReservationsInput{} } output = &ListReservationsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ListReservations API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // List purchased reservations. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation ListReservations for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListReservations func (c *MediaLive) ListReservations(input *ListReservationsInput) (*ListReservationsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListReservationsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ListReservationsWithContext is the same as ListReservations with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ListReservations for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListReservationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListReservationsOutput, error) { req, out := c.ListReservationsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // ListReservationsPages iterates over the pages of a ListReservations operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See ListReservations method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListReservations operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.ListReservationsPages(params, // func(page *ListReservationsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsPages(input *ListReservationsInput, fn func(*ListReservationsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.ListReservationsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // ListReservationsPagesWithContext same as ListReservationsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListReservationsInput, fn func(*ListReservationsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *ListReservationsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.ListReservationsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListReservationsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opPurchaseOffering = "PurchaseOffering" // PurchaseOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the PurchaseOffering operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See PurchaseOffering for more information on using the PurchaseOffering // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the PurchaseOfferingRequest method. // req, resp := client.PurchaseOfferingRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/PurchaseOffering func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseOfferingOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opPurchaseOffering, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings/{offeringId}/purchase", } if input == nil { input = &PurchaseOfferingInput{} } output = &PurchaseOfferingOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // PurchaseOffering API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Purchase an offering and create a reservation. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation PurchaseOffering for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/PurchaseOffering func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOffering(input *PurchaseOfferingInput) (*PurchaseOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.PurchaseOfferingRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // PurchaseOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseOffering with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See PurchaseOffering for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.PurchaseOfferingRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opStartChannel = "StartChannel" // StartChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the StartChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See StartChannel for more information on using the StartChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the StartChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.StartChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StartChannel func (c *MediaLive) StartChannelRequest(input *StartChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opStartChannel, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/start", } if input == nil { input = &StartChannelInput{} } output = &StartChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // StartChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Starts an existing channel // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation StartChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StartChannel func (c *MediaLive) StartChannel(input *StartChannelInput) (*StartChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.StartChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // StartChannelWithContext is the same as StartChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See StartChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) StartChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.StartChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opStopChannel = "StopChannel" // StopChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the StopChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See StopChannel for more information on using the StopChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the StopChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.StopChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StopChannel func (c *MediaLive) StopChannelRequest(input *StopChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opStopChannel, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/stop", } if input == nil { input = &StopChannelInput{} } output = &StopChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // StopChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Stops a running channel // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation StopChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StopChannel func (c *MediaLive) StopChannel(input *StopChannelInput) (*StopChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.StopChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // StopChannelWithContext is the same as StopChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See StopChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) StopChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.StopChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateChannel = "UpdateChannel" // UpdateChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateChannel operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateChannel for more information on using the UpdateChannel // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateChannelRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateChannelRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateChannel func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannelRequest(input *UpdateChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateChannelOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateChannel, HTTPMethod: "PUT", HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateChannelInput{} } output = &UpdateChannelOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UpdateChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Updates a channel. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation UpdateChannel for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateChannel func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannel(input *UpdateChannelInput) (*UpdateChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateChannelRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateChannelWithContext is the same as UpdateChannel with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateChannel for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateChannelOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateChannelRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateInput = "UpdateInput" // UpdateInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateInput operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateInput for more information on using the UpdateInput // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateInputRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateInputRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInput func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputRequest(input *UpdateInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateInputOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateInput, HTTPMethod: "PUT", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateInputInput{} } output = &UpdateInputOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UpdateInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Updates an input. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation UpdateInput for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInput func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInput(input *UpdateInputInput) (*UpdateInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateInputRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateInputWithContext is the same as UpdateInput with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateInput for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateInputOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateInputRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opUpdateInputSecurityGroup = "UpdateInputSecurityGroup" // UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the UpdateInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See UpdateInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the UpdateInputSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opUpdateInputSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "PUT", HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}", } if input == nil { input = &UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // UpdateInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive. // // Update an Input Security Group's Whilelists. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's // API operation UpdateInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException" // // * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException" // // * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException" // // * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException" // // * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException" // // * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException" // // * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException" // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInputSecurityGroup func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroup(input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) (*UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // UpdateInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as UpdateInputSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See UpdateInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } type AacSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid values depend on rate control mode // and profile. Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"` // Mono, Stereo, or 5.1 channel layout. Valid values depend on rate control // mode and profile. The adReceiverMix setting receives a stereo description // plus control track and emits a mono AAC encode of the description track, // with control data emitted in the PES header as per ETSI TS 101 154 Annex // E. CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"AacCodingMode"` // Set to "broadcasterMixedAd" when input contains pre-mixed main audio + AD // (narration) as a stereo pair. The Audio Type field (audioType) will be set // to 3, which signals to downstream systems that this stream contains "broadcaster // mixed AD". Note that the input received by the encoder must contain pre-mixed // audio; the encoder does not perform the mixing. The values in audioTypeControl // and audioType (in AudioDescription) are ignored when set to broadcasterMixedAd.Leave // set to "normal" when input does not contain pre-mixed audio + AD. InputType *string `locationName:"inputType" type:"string" enum:"AacInputType"` // AAC Profile. Profile *string `locationName:"profile" type:"string" enum:"AacProfile"` // Rate Control Mode. RateControlMode *string `locationName:"rateControlMode" type:"string" enum:"AacRateControlMode"` // Sets LATM / LOAS AAC output for raw containers. RawFormat *string `locationName:"rawFormat" type:"string" enum:"AacRawFormat"` // Sample rate in Hz. Valid values depend on rate control mode and profile. SampleRate *float64 `locationName:"sampleRate" type:"double"` // Use MPEG-2 AAC audio instead of MPEG-4 AAC audio for raw or MPEG-2 Transport // Stream containers. Spec *string `locationName:"spec" type:"string" enum:"AacSpec"` // VBR Quality Level - Only used if rateControlMode is VBR. VbrQuality *string `locationName:"vbrQuality" type:"string" enum:"AacVbrQuality"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AacSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AacSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetBitrate(v float64) *AacSettings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetCodingMode(v string) *AacSettings { s.CodingMode = &v return s } // SetInputType sets the InputType field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetInputType(v string) *AacSettings { s.InputType = &v return s } // SetProfile sets the Profile field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetProfile(v string) *AacSettings { s.Profile = &v return s } // SetRateControlMode sets the RateControlMode field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetRateControlMode(v string) *AacSettings { s.RateControlMode = &v return s } // SetRawFormat sets the RawFormat field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetRawFormat(v string) *AacSettings { s.RawFormat = &v return s } // SetSampleRate sets the SampleRate field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetSampleRate(v float64) *AacSettings { s.SampleRate = &v return s } // SetSpec sets the Spec field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetSpec(v string) *AacSettings { s.Spec = &v return s } // SetVbrQuality sets the VbrQuality field's value. func (s *AacSettings) SetVbrQuality(v string) *AacSettings { s.VbrQuality = &v return s } type Ac3Settings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode. Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"` // Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted AC-3 stream. See ATSC // A/52-2012 for background on these values. BitstreamMode *string `locationName:"bitstreamMode" type:"string" enum:"Ac3BitstreamMode"` // Dolby Digital coding mode. Determines number of channels. CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Ac3CodingMode"` // Sets the dialnorm for the output. If excluded and input audio is Dolby Digital, // dialnorm will be passed through. Dialnorm *int64 `locationName:"dialnorm" min:"1" type:"integer"` // If set to filmStandard, adds dynamic range compression signaling to the output // bitstream as defined in the Dolby Digital specification. DrcProfile *string `locationName:"drcProfile" type:"string" enum:"Ac3DrcProfile"` // When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior // to encoding. Only valid in codingMode32Lfe mode. LfeFilter *string `locationName:"lfeFilter" type:"string" enum:"Ac3LfeFilter"` // When set to "followInput", encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD, // DD+, or DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied // from one of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used. MetadataControl *string `locationName:"metadataControl" type:"string" enum:"Ac3MetadataControl"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Ac3Settings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Ac3Settings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Ac3Settings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Ac3Settings"} if s.Dialnorm != nil && *s.Dialnorm < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Dialnorm", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Ac3Settings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetBitstreamMode sets the BitstreamMode field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetBitstreamMode(v string) *Ac3Settings { s.BitstreamMode = &v return s } // SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Ac3Settings { s.CodingMode = &v return s } // SetDialnorm sets the Dialnorm field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetDialnorm(v int64) *Ac3Settings { s.Dialnorm = &v return s } // SetDrcProfile sets the DrcProfile field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetDrcProfile(v string) *Ac3Settings { s.DrcProfile = &v return s } // SetLfeFilter sets the LfeFilter field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetLfeFilter(v string) *Ac3Settings { s.LfeFilter = &v return s } // SetMetadataControl sets the MetadataControl field's value. func (s *Ac3Settings) SetMetadataControl(v string) *Ac3Settings { s.MetadataControl = &v return s } type ArchiveContainerSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings `locationName:"m2tsSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ArchiveContainerSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ArchiveContainerSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ArchiveContainerSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveContainerSettings"} if s.M2tsSettings != nil { if err := s.M2tsSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("M2tsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetM2tsSettings sets the M2tsSettings field's value. func (s *ArchiveContainerSettings) SetM2tsSettings(v *M2tsSettings) *ArchiveContainerSettings { s.M2tsSettings = v return s } type ArchiveGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A directory and base filename where archive files should be written. // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Number of seconds to write to archive file before closing and starting a // new one. RolloverInterval *int64 `locationName:"rolloverInterval" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ArchiveGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ArchiveGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveGroupSettings"} if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if s.RolloverInterval != nil && *s.RolloverInterval < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RolloverInterval", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *ArchiveGroupSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // SetRolloverInterval sets the RolloverInterval field's value. func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) SetRolloverInterval(v int64) *ArchiveGroupSettings { s.RolloverInterval = &v return s } type ArchiveOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Settings specific to the container type of the file. // // ContainerSettings is a required field ContainerSettings *ArchiveContainerSettings `locationName:"containerSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Output file extension. If excluded, this will be auto-selected from the container // type. Extension *string `locationName:"extension" type:"string"` // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for // multiple outputs of the same type. NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ArchiveOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ArchiveOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveOutputSettings"} if s.ContainerSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ContainerSettings")) } if s.ContainerSettings != nil { if err := s.ContainerSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ContainerSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetContainerSettings sets the ContainerSettings field's value. func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetContainerSettings(v *ArchiveContainerSettings) *ArchiveOutputSettings { s.ContainerSettings = v return s } // SetExtension sets the Extension field's value. func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetExtension(v string) *ArchiveOutputSettings { s.Extension = &v return s } // SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value. func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *ArchiveOutputSettings { s.NameModifier = &v return s } type AribDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AribDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AribDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AribSourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AribSourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AribSourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type AudioChannelMapping struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Indices and gain values for each input channel that should be remixed into // this output channel. // // InputChannelLevels is a required field InputChannelLevels []*InputChannelLevel `locationName:"inputChannelLevels" type:"list" required:"true"` // The index of the output channel being produced. // // OutputChannel is a required field OutputChannel *int64 `locationName:"outputChannel" type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioChannelMapping) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioChannelMapping) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioChannelMapping) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioChannelMapping"} if s.InputChannelLevels == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputChannelLevels")) } if s.OutputChannel == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputChannel")) } if s.InputChannelLevels != nil { for i, v := range s.InputChannelLevels { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputChannelLevels", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputChannelLevels sets the InputChannelLevels field's value. func (s *AudioChannelMapping) SetInputChannelLevels(v []*InputChannelLevel) *AudioChannelMapping { s.InputChannelLevels = v return s } // SetOutputChannel sets the OutputChannel field's value. func (s *AudioChannelMapping) SetOutputChannel(v int64) *AudioChannelMapping { s.OutputChannel = &v return s } type AudioCodecSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AacSettings *AacSettings `locationName:"aacSettings" type:"structure"` Ac3Settings *Ac3Settings `locationName:"ac3Settings" type:"structure"` Eac3Settings *Eac3Settings `locationName:"eac3Settings" type:"structure"` Mp2Settings *Mp2Settings `locationName:"mp2Settings" type:"structure"` PassThroughSettings *PassThroughSettings `locationName:"passThroughSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioCodecSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioCodecSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioCodecSettings"} if s.Ac3Settings != nil { if err := s.Ac3Settings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Ac3Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Eac3Settings != nil { if err := s.Eac3Settings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Eac3Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAacSettings sets the AacSettings field's value. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetAacSettings(v *AacSettings) *AudioCodecSettings { s.AacSettings = v return s } // SetAc3Settings sets the Ac3Settings field's value. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetAc3Settings(v *Ac3Settings) *AudioCodecSettings { s.Ac3Settings = v return s } // SetEac3Settings sets the Eac3Settings field's value. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetEac3Settings(v *Eac3Settings) *AudioCodecSettings { s.Eac3Settings = v return s } // SetMp2Settings sets the Mp2Settings field's value. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetMp2Settings(v *Mp2Settings) *AudioCodecSettings { s.Mp2Settings = v return s } // SetPassThroughSettings sets the PassThroughSettings field's value. func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetPassThroughSettings(v *PassThroughSettings) *AudioCodecSettings { s.PassThroughSettings = v return s } type AudioDescription struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Advanced audio normalization settings. AudioNormalizationSettings *AudioNormalizationSettings `locationName:"audioNormalizationSettings" type:"structure"` // The name of the AudioSelector used as the source for this AudioDescription. // // AudioSelectorName is a required field AudioSelectorName *string `locationName:"audioSelectorName" type:"string" required:"true"` // Applies only if audioTypeControl is useConfigured. The values for audioType // are defined in ISO-IEC 13818-1. AudioType *string `locationName:"audioType" type:"string" enum:"AudioType"` // Determines how audio type is determined. followInput: If the input contains // an ISO 639 audioType, then that value is passed through to the output. If // the input contains no ISO 639 audioType, the value in Audio Type is included // in the output. useConfigured: The value in Audio Type is included in the // output.Note that this field and audioType are both ignored if inputType is // broadcasterMixedAd. AudioTypeControl *string `locationName:"audioTypeControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl"` // Audio codec settings. CodecSettings *AudioCodecSettings `locationName:"codecSettings" type:"structure"` // Indicates the language of the audio output track. Only used if languageControlMode // is useConfigured, or there is no ISO 639 language code specified in the input. LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" min:"3" type:"string"` // Choosing followInput will cause the ISO 639 language code of the output to // follow the ISO 639 language code of the input. The languageCode will be used // when useConfigured is set, or when followInput is selected but there is no // ISO 639 language code specified by the input. LanguageCodeControl *string `locationName:"languageCodeControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl"` // The name of this AudioDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely // identify this AudioDescription. Description names should be unique within // this Live Event. // // Name is a required field Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"` // Settings that control how input audio channels are remixed into the output // audio channels. RemixSettings *RemixSettings `locationName:"remixSettings" type:"structure"` // Used for MS Smooth and Apple HLS outputs. Indicates the name displayed by // the player (eg. English, or Director Commentary). StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioDescription) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioDescription) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioDescription) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioDescription"} if s.AudioSelectorName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AudioSelectorName")) } if s.LanguageCode != nil && len(*s.LanguageCode) < 3 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageCode", 3)) } if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.CodecSettings != nil { if err := s.CodecSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("CodecSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.RemixSettings != nil { if err := s.RemixSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("RemixSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioNormalizationSettings sets the AudioNormalizationSettings field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioNormalizationSettings(v *AudioNormalizationSettings) *AudioDescription { s.AudioNormalizationSettings = v return s } // SetAudioSelectorName sets the AudioSelectorName field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioSelectorName(v string) *AudioDescription { s.AudioSelectorName = &v return s } // SetAudioType sets the AudioType field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioType(v string) *AudioDescription { s.AudioType = &v return s } // SetAudioTypeControl sets the AudioTypeControl field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioTypeControl(v string) *AudioDescription { s.AudioTypeControl = &v return s } // SetCodecSettings sets the CodecSettings field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetCodecSettings(v *AudioCodecSettings) *AudioDescription { s.CodecSettings = v return s } // SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetLanguageCode(v string) *AudioDescription { s.LanguageCode = &v return s } // SetLanguageCodeControl sets the LanguageCodeControl field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetLanguageCodeControl(v string) *AudioDescription { s.LanguageCodeControl = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetName(v string) *AudioDescription { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRemixSettings sets the RemixSettings field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetRemixSettings(v *RemixSettings) *AudioDescription { s.RemixSettings = v return s } // SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value. func (s *AudioDescription) SetStreamName(v string) *AudioDescription { s.StreamName = &v return s } type AudioLanguageSelection struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Selects a specific three-letter language code from within an audio source. // // LanguageCode is a required field LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string" required:"true"` // When set to "strict", the transport stream demux strictly identifies audio // streams by their language descriptor. If a PMT update occurs such that an // audio stream matching the initially selected language is no longer present // then mute will be encoded until the language returns. If "loose", then on // a PMT update the demux will choose another audio stream in the program with // the same stream type if it can't find one with the same language. LanguageSelectionPolicy *string `locationName:"languageSelectionPolicy" type:"string" enum:"AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioLanguageSelection) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioLanguageSelection) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioLanguageSelection"} if s.LanguageCode == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageCode")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value. func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) SetLanguageCode(v string) *AudioLanguageSelection { s.LanguageCode = &v return s } // SetLanguageSelectionPolicy sets the LanguageSelectionPolicy field's value. func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) SetLanguageSelectionPolicy(v string) *AudioLanguageSelection { s.LanguageSelectionPolicy = &v return s } type AudioNormalizationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Audio normalization algorithm to use. itu17701 conforms to the CALM Act specification, // itu17702 conforms to the EBU R-128 specification. Algorithm *string `locationName:"algorithm" type:"string" enum:"AudioNormalizationAlgorithm"` // When set to correctAudio the output audio is corrected using the chosen algorithm. // If set to measureOnly, the audio will be measured but not adjusted. AlgorithmControl *string `locationName:"algorithmControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl"` // Target LKFS(loudness) to adjust volume to. If no value is entered, a default // value will be used according to the chosen algorithm. The CALM Act (1770-1) // recommends a target of -24 LKFS. The EBU R-128 specification (1770-2) recommends // a target of -23 LKFS. TargetLkfs *float64 `locationName:"targetLkfs" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioNormalizationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioNormalizationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAlgorithm sets the Algorithm field's value. func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetAlgorithm(v string) *AudioNormalizationSettings { s.Algorithm = &v return s } // SetAlgorithmControl sets the AlgorithmControl field's value. func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetAlgorithmControl(v string) *AudioNormalizationSettings { s.AlgorithmControl = &v return s } // SetTargetLkfs sets the TargetLkfs field's value. func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetTargetLkfs(v float64) *AudioNormalizationSettings { s.TargetLkfs = &v return s } type AudioOnlyHlsSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies the group to which the audio Rendition belongs. AudioGroupId *string `locationName:"audioGroupId" type:"string"` // For use with an audio only Stream. Must be a .jpg or .png file. If given, // this image will be used as the cover-art for the audio only output. Ideally, // it should be formatted for an iPhone screen for two reasons. The iPhone does // not resize the image, it crops a centered image on the top/bottom and left/right. // Additionally, this image file gets saved bit-for-bit into every 10-second // segment file, so will increase bandwidth by {image file size} * {segment // count} * {user count.}. AudioOnlyImage *InputLocation `locationName:"audioOnlyImage" type:"structure"` // Four types of audio-only tracks are supported:Audio-Only Variant StreamThe // client can play back this audio-only stream instead of video in low-bandwidth // scenarios. Represented as an EXT-X-STREAM-INF in the HLS manifest.Alternate // Audio, Auto Select, DefaultAlternate rendition that the client should try // to play back by default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest // with DEFAULT=YES, AUTOSELECT=YESAlternate Audio, Auto Select, Not DefaultAlternate // rendition that the client may try to play back by default. Represented as // an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with DEFAULT=NO, AUTOSELECT=YESAlternate // Audio, not Auto SelectAlternate rendition that the client will not try to // play back by default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with // DEFAULT=NO, AUTOSELECT=NO AudioTrackType *string `locationName:"audioTrackType" type:"string" enum:"AudioOnlyHlsTrackType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioOnlyHlsSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioOnlyHlsSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioOnlyHlsSettings"} if s.AudioOnlyImage != nil { if err := s.AudioOnlyImage.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AudioOnlyImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioGroupId sets the AudioGroupId field's value. func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioGroupId(v string) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings { s.AudioGroupId = &v return s } // SetAudioOnlyImage sets the AudioOnlyImage field's value. func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioOnlyImage(v *InputLocation) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings { s.AudioOnlyImage = v return s } // SetAudioTrackType sets the AudioTrackType field's value. func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioTrackType(v string) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings { s.AudioTrackType = &v return s } type AudioPidSelection struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Selects a specific PID from within a source. // // Pid is a required field Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioPidSelection) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioPidSelection) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioPidSelection) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioPidSelection"} if s.Pid == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Pid")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPid sets the Pid field's value. func (s *AudioPidSelection) SetPid(v int64) *AudioPidSelection { s.Pid = &v return s } type AudioSelector struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of this AudioSelector. AudioDescriptions will use this name to uniquely // identify this Selector. Selector names should be unique per input. // // Name is a required field Name *string `locationName:"name" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The audio selector settings. SelectorSettings *AudioSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioSelector) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioSelector) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioSelector) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioSelector"} if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1)) } if s.SelectorSettings != nil { if err := s.SelectorSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("SelectorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *AudioSelector) SetName(v string) *AudioSelector { s.Name = &v return s } // SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value. func (s *AudioSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *AudioSelectorSettings) *AudioSelector { s.SelectorSettings = v return s } type AudioSelectorSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AudioLanguageSelection *AudioLanguageSelection `locationName:"audioLanguageSelection" type:"structure"` AudioPidSelection *AudioPidSelection `locationName:"audioPidSelection" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AudioSelectorSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AudioSelectorSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioSelectorSettings"} if s.AudioLanguageSelection != nil { if err := s.AudioLanguageSelection.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AudioLanguageSelection", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.AudioPidSelection != nil { if err := s.AudioPidSelection.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AudioPidSelection", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioLanguageSelection sets the AudioLanguageSelection field's value. func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) SetAudioLanguageSelection(v *AudioLanguageSelection) *AudioSelectorSettings { s.AudioLanguageSelection = v return s } // SetAudioPidSelection sets the AudioPidSelection field's value. func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) SetAudioPidSelection(v *AudioPidSelection) *AudioSelectorSettings { s.AudioPidSelection = v return s } type AvailBlanking struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Blanking image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and png // images are supported. AvailBlankingImage *InputLocation `locationName:"availBlankingImage" type:"structure"` // When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when // insertion metadata is added. State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"AvailBlankingState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AvailBlanking) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AvailBlanking) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AvailBlanking) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailBlanking"} if s.AvailBlankingImage != nil { if err := s.AvailBlankingImage.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AvailBlankingImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAvailBlankingImage sets the AvailBlankingImage field's value. func (s *AvailBlanking) SetAvailBlankingImage(v *InputLocation) *AvailBlanking { s.AvailBlankingImage = v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *AvailBlanking) SetState(v string) *AvailBlanking { s.State = &v return s } type AvailConfiguration struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Ad avail settings. AvailSettings *AvailSettings `locationName:"availSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AvailConfiguration) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AvailConfiguration) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AvailConfiguration) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailConfiguration"} if s.AvailSettings != nil { if err := s.AvailSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AvailSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAvailSettings sets the AvailSettings field's value. func (s *AvailConfiguration) SetAvailSettings(v *AvailSettings) *AvailConfiguration { s.AvailSettings = v return s } type AvailSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Scte35SpliceInsert *Scte35SpliceInsert `locationName:"scte35SpliceInsert" type:"structure"` Scte35TimeSignalApos *Scte35TimeSignalApos `locationName:"scte35TimeSignalApos" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AvailSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AvailSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AvailSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailSettings"} if s.Scte35SpliceInsert != nil { if err := s.Scte35SpliceInsert.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35SpliceInsert", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte35TimeSignalApos != nil { if err := s.Scte35TimeSignalApos.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35TimeSignalApos", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScte35SpliceInsert sets the Scte35SpliceInsert field's value. func (s *AvailSettings) SetScte35SpliceInsert(v *Scte35SpliceInsert) *AvailSettings { s.Scte35SpliceInsert = v return s } // SetScte35TimeSignalApos sets the Scte35TimeSignalApos field's value. func (s *AvailSettings) SetScte35TimeSignalApos(v *Scte35TimeSignalApos) *AvailSettings { s.Scte35TimeSignalApos = v return s } // A list of schedule actions to create (in a request) or that have been created // (in a response). type BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of schedule actions to create. // // ScheduleActions is a required field ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest"} if s.ScheduleActions == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActions")) } if s.ScheduleActions != nil { for i, v := range s.ScheduleActions { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ScheduleActions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value. func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest { s.ScheduleActions = v return s } // List of actions that have been created in the schedule. type BatchScheduleActionCreateResult struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // List of actions that have been created in the schedule. // // ScheduleActions is a required field ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value. func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult { s.ScheduleActions = v return s } // A list of schedule actions to delete. type BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of schedule actions to delete. // // ActionNames is a required field ActionNames []*string `locationName:"actionNames" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest"} if s.ActionNames == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionNames")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetActionNames sets the ActionNames field's value. func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) SetActionNames(v []*string) *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest { s.ActionNames = v return s } // List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule. type BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule. // // ScheduleActions is a required field ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value. func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult { s.ScheduleActions = v return s } // A request to create actions (add actions to the schedule), delete actions // (remove actions from the schedule), or both create and delete actions. type BatchUpdateScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` // Schedule actions to create in the schedule. Creates *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest `locationName:"creates" type:"structure"` // Schedule actions to delete from the schedule. Deletes *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest `locationName:"deletes" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchUpdateScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchUpdateScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchUpdateScheduleInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if s.Creates != nil { if err := s.Creates.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Creates", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Deletes != nil { if err := s.Deletes.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Deletes", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetChannelId(v string) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } // SetCreates sets the Creates field's value. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetCreates(v *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput { s.Creates = v return s } // SetDeletes sets the Deletes field's value. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetDeletes(v *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput { s.Deletes = v return s } type BatchUpdateScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // List of actions that have been created in the schedule. Creates *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult `locationName:"creates" type:"structure"` // List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule. Deletes *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult `locationName:"deletes" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCreates sets the Creates field's value. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) SetCreates(v *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput { s.Creates = v return s } // SetDeletes sets the Deletes field's value. func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) SetDeletes(v *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput { s.Deletes = v return s } type BlackoutSlate struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Blackout slate image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and // png images are supported. BlackoutSlateImage *InputLocation `locationName:"blackoutSlateImage" type:"structure"` // Setting to enabled causes the encoder to blackout the video, audio, and captions, // and raise the "Network Blackout Image" slate when an SCTE104/35 Network End // Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The blackout will be lifted when // the Network Start Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The Network End // and Network Start descriptors must contain a network ID that matches the // value entered in "Network ID". NetworkEndBlackout *string `locationName:"networkEndBlackout" type:"string" enum:"BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout"` // Path to local file to use as Network End Blackout image. Image will be scaled // to fill the entire output raster. NetworkEndBlackoutImage *InputLocation `locationName:"networkEndBlackoutImage" type:"structure"` // Provides Network ID that matches EIDR ID format (e.g., "10.XXXX/XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-C"). NetworkId *string `locationName:"networkId" min:"34" type:"string"` // When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when // indicated by program metadata. State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"BlackoutSlateState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BlackoutSlate) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BlackoutSlate) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BlackoutSlate) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BlackoutSlate"} if s.NetworkId != nil && len(*s.NetworkId) < 34 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NetworkId", 34)) } if s.BlackoutSlateImage != nil { if err := s.BlackoutSlateImage.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("BlackoutSlateImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage != nil { if err := s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("NetworkEndBlackoutImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetBlackoutSlateImage sets the BlackoutSlateImage field's value. func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetBlackoutSlateImage(v *InputLocation) *BlackoutSlate { s.BlackoutSlateImage = v return s } // SetNetworkEndBlackout sets the NetworkEndBlackout field's value. func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkEndBlackout(v string) *BlackoutSlate { s.NetworkEndBlackout = &v return s } // SetNetworkEndBlackoutImage sets the NetworkEndBlackoutImage field's value. func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkEndBlackoutImage(v *InputLocation) *BlackoutSlate { s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage = v return s } // SetNetworkId sets the NetworkId field's value. func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkId(v string) *BlackoutSlate { s.NetworkId = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetState(v string) *BlackoutSlate { s.State = &v return s } type BurnInDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered // will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting // a left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If // x and y positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter, // the font will be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates. // Selecting "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify // pre-recorded subtitles. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Alignment *string `locationName:"alignment" type:"string" enum:"BurnInAlignment"` // Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundColor *string `locationName:"backgroundColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInBackgroundColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. // Leaving this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundOpacity *int64 `locationName:"backgroundOpacity" type:"integer"` // External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf' // or 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types // of input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system. // Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display // of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Font *InputLocation `locationName:"font" type:"structure"` // Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for // source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. FontColor *string `locationName:"fontColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInFontColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontOpacity *int64 `locationName:"fontOpacity" type:"integer"` // Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontResolution *int64 `locationName:"fontResolution" min:"96" type:"integer"` // When set to 'auto' fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output. // Giving a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontSize *string `locationName:"fontSize" type:"string"` // Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions // that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already // pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings // must match. OutlineColor *string `locationName:"outlineColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInOutlineColor"` // Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source // captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. OutlineSize *int64 `locationName:"outlineSize" type:"integer"` // Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub // font settings must match. ShadowColor *string `locationName:"shadowColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInShadowColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving // this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All burn-in // and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowOpacity *int64 `locationName:"shadowOpacity" type:"integer"` // Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in // pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowXOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowXOffset" type:"integer"` // Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels. // A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowYOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowYOffset" type:"integer"` // Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles // bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs. TeletextGridControl *string `locationName:"teletextGridControl" type:"string" enum:"BurnInTeletextGridControl"` // Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side // of the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting // 10 pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided, // the horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. XPosition *int64 `locationName:"xPosition" type:"integer"` // Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the // output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 // pixels from the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided, // the caption will be positioned towards the bottom of the output. All burn-in // and DVB-Sub font settings must match. YPosition *int64 `locationName:"yPosition" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BurnInDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BurnInDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BurnInDestinationSettings"} if s.FontResolution != nil && *s.FontResolution < 96 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FontResolution", 96)) } if s.Font != nil { if err := s.Font.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Font", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAlignment sets the Alignment field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetAlignment(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.Alignment = &v return s } // SetBackgroundColor sets the BackgroundColor field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.BackgroundColor = &v return s } // SetBackgroundOpacity sets the BackgroundOpacity field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.BackgroundOpacity = &v return s } // SetFont sets the Font field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFont(v *InputLocation) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.Font = v return s } // SetFontColor sets the FontColor field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.FontColor = &v return s } // SetFontOpacity sets the FontOpacity field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.FontOpacity = &v return s } // SetFontResolution sets the FontResolution field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontResolution(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.FontResolution = &v return s } // SetFontSize sets the FontSize field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontSize(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.FontSize = &v return s } // SetOutlineColor sets the OutlineColor field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetOutlineColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.OutlineColor = &v return s } // SetOutlineSize sets the OutlineSize field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetOutlineSize(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.OutlineSize = &v return s } // SetShadowColor sets the ShadowColor field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.ShadowColor = &v return s } // SetShadowOpacity sets the ShadowOpacity field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.ShadowOpacity = &v return s } // SetShadowXOffset sets the ShadowXOffset field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowXOffset(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.ShadowXOffset = &v return s } // SetShadowYOffset sets the ShadowYOffset field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowYOffset(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.ShadowYOffset = &v return s } // SetTeletextGridControl sets the TeletextGridControl field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetTeletextGridControl(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.TeletextGridControl = &v return s } // SetXPosition sets the XPosition field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetXPosition(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.XPosition = &v return s } // SetYPosition sets the YPosition field's value. func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetYPosition(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings { s.YPosition = &v return s } // Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about // where streams should be distributed. type CaptionDescription struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies which input caption selector to use as a caption source when generating // output captions. This field should match a captionSelector name. // // CaptionSelectorName is a required field CaptionSelectorName *string `locationName:"captionSelectorName" type:"string" required:"true"` // Additional settings for captions destination that depend on the destination // type. DestinationSettings *CaptionDestinationSettings `locationName:"destinationSettings" type:"structure"` // ISO 639-2 three-digit code: http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2/ LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string"` // Human readable information to indicate captions available for players (eg. // English, or Spanish). LanguageDescription *string `locationName:"languageDescription" type:"string"` // Name of the caption description. Used to associate a caption description // with an output. Names must be unique within an event. // // Name is a required field Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CaptionDescription) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CaptionDescription) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CaptionDescription) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionDescription"} if s.CaptionSelectorName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CaptionSelectorName")) } if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.DestinationSettings != nil { if err := s.DestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCaptionSelectorName sets the CaptionSelectorName field's value. func (s *CaptionDescription) SetCaptionSelectorName(v string) *CaptionDescription { s.CaptionSelectorName = &v return s } // SetDestinationSettings sets the DestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDescription) SetDestinationSettings(v *CaptionDestinationSettings) *CaptionDescription { s.DestinationSettings = v return s } // SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value. func (s *CaptionDescription) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionDescription { s.LanguageCode = &v return s } // SetLanguageDescription sets the LanguageDescription field's value. func (s *CaptionDescription) SetLanguageDescription(v string) *CaptionDescription { s.LanguageDescription = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *CaptionDescription) SetName(v string) *CaptionDescription { s.Name = &v return s } type CaptionDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AribDestinationSettings *AribDestinationSettings `locationName:"aribDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` BurnInDestinationSettings *BurnInDestinationSettings `locationName:"burnInDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` DvbSubDestinationSettings *DvbSubDestinationSettings `locationName:"dvbSubDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` EmbeddedDestinationSettings *EmbeddedDestinationSettings `locationName:"embeddedDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings *EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings `locationName:"embeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings" type:"structure"` RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings *RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings `locationName:"rtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings *Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings `locationName:"scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` Scte27DestinationSettings *Scte27DestinationSettings `locationName:"scte27DestinationSettings" type:"structure"` SmpteTtDestinationSettings *SmpteTtDestinationSettings `locationName:"smpteTtDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` TeletextDestinationSettings *TeletextDestinationSettings `locationName:"teletextDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` TtmlDestinationSettings *TtmlDestinationSettings `locationName:"ttmlDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` WebvttDestinationSettings *WebvttDestinationSettings `locationName:"webvttDestinationSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CaptionDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CaptionDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionDestinationSettings"} if s.BurnInDestinationSettings != nil { if err := s.BurnInDestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("BurnInDestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.DvbSubDestinationSettings != nil { if err := s.DvbSubDestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSubDestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAribDestinationSettings sets the AribDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetAribDestinationSettings(v *AribDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.AribDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetBurnInDestinationSettings sets the BurnInDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetBurnInDestinationSettings(v *BurnInDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.BurnInDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetDvbSubDestinationSettings sets the DvbSubDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetDvbSubDestinationSettings(v *DvbSubDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.DvbSubDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetEmbeddedDestinationSettings sets the EmbeddedDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetEmbeddedDestinationSettings(v *EmbeddedDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.EmbeddedDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetEmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings sets the EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetEmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings(v *EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings = v return s } // SetRtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings sets the RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetRtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings(v *RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetScte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings sets the Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetScte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings(v *Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetScte27DestinationSettings sets the Scte27DestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetScte27DestinationSettings(v *Scte27DestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.Scte27DestinationSettings = v return s } // SetSmpteTtDestinationSettings sets the SmpteTtDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetSmpteTtDestinationSettings(v *SmpteTtDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.SmpteTtDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetTeletextDestinationSettings sets the TeletextDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetTeletextDestinationSettings(v *TeletextDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.TeletextDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetTtmlDestinationSettings sets the TtmlDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetTtmlDestinationSettings(v *TtmlDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.TtmlDestinationSettings = v return s } // SetWebvttDestinationSettings sets the WebvttDestinationSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetWebvttDestinationSettings(v *WebvttDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings { s.WebvttDestinationSettings = v return s } // Maps a caption channel to an ISO 693-2 language code (http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2), // with an optional description. type CaptionLanguageMapping struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The closed caption channel being described by this CaptionLanguageMapping. // Each channel mapping must have a unique channel number (maximum of 4) // // CaptionChannel is a required field CaptionChannel *int64 `locationName:"captionChannel" min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"` // Three character ISO 639-2 language code (see http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2) // // LanguageCode is a required field LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" min:"3" type:"string" required:"true"` // Textual description of language // // LanguageDescription is a required field LanguageDescription *string `locationName:"languageDescription" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CaptionLanguageMapping) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CaptionLanguageMapping) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionLanguageMapping"} if s.CaptionChannel == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CaptionChannel")) } if s.CaptionChannel != nil && *s.CaptionChannel < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("CaptionChannel", 1)) } if s.LanguageCode == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageCode")) } if s.LanguageCode != nil && len(*s.LanguageCode) < 3 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageCode", 3)) } if s.LanguageDescription == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageDescription")) } if s.LanguageDescription != nil && len(*s.LanguageDescription) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageDescription", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCaptionChannel sets the CaptionChannel field's value. func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetCaptionChannel(v int64) *CaptionLanguageMapping { s.CaptionChannel = &v return s } // SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value. func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionLanguageMapping { s.LanguageCode = &v return s } // SetLanguageDescription sets the LanguageDescription field's value. func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetLanguageDescription(v string) *CaptionLanguageMapping { s.LanguageDescription = &v return s } // Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about // where streams should be distributed. type CaptionSelector struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When specified this field indicates the three letter language code of the // caption track to extract from the source. LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string"` // Name identifier for a caption selector. This name is used to associate this // caption selector with one or more caption descriptions. Names must be unique // within an event. // // Name is a required field Name *string `locationName:"name" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // Caption selector settings. SelectorSettings *CaptionSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CaptionSelector) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CaptionSelector) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CaptionSelector) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionSelector"} if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1)) } if s.SelectorSettings != nil { if err := s.SelectorSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("SelectorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value. func (s *CaptionSelector) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionSelector { s.LanguageCode = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *CaptionSelector) SetName(v string) *CaptionSelector { s.Name = &v return s } // SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *CaptionSelectorSettings) *CaptionSelector { s.SelectorSettings = v return s } type CaptionSelectorSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AribSourceSettings *AribSourceSettings `locationName:"aribSourceSettings" type:"structure"` DvbSubSourceSettings *DvbSubSourceSettings `locationName:"dvbSubSourceSettings" type:"structure"` EmbeddedSourceSettings *EmbeddedSourceSettings `locationName:"embeddedSourceSettings" type:"structure"` Scte20SourceSettings *Scte20SourceSettings `locationName:"scte20SourceSettings" type:"structure"` Scte27SourceSettings *Scte27SourceSettings `locationName:"scte27SourceSettings" type:"structure"` TeletextSourceSettings *TeletextSourceSettings `locationName:"teletextSourceSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CaptionSelectorSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CaptionSelectorSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionSelectorSettings"} if s.DvbSubSourceSettings != nil { if err := s.DvbSubSourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSubSourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.EmbeddedSourceSettings != nil { if err := s.EmbeddedSourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("EmbeddedSourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte20SourceSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte20SourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte20SourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte27SourceSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte27SourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte27SourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAribSourceSettings sets the AribSourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetAribSourceSettings(v *AribSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.AribSourceSettings = v return s } // SetDvbSubSourceSettings sets the DvbSubSourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetDvbSubSourceSettings(v *DvbSubSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.DvbSubSourceSettings = v return s } // SetEmbeddedSourceSettings sets the EmbeddedSourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetEmbeddedSourceSettings(v *EmbeddedSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.EmbeddedSourceSettings = v return s } // SetScte20SourceSettings sets the Scte20SourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetScte20SourceSettings(v *Scte20SourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.Scte20SourceSettings = v return s } // SetScte27SourceSettings sets the Scte27SourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetScte27SourceSettings(v *Scte27SourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.Scte27SourceSettings = v return s } // SetTeletextSourceSettings sets the TeletextSourceSettings field's value. func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetTeletextSourceSettings(v *TeletextSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings { s.TeletextSourceSettings = v return s } type Channel struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique arn of the channel. Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is onedestination // per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there isone destination per // packager. Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` // The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` // The unique id of the channel. Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` // List of input attachments for channel. InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` // The name of the channel. (user-mutable) Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel. RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Channel) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Channel) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Channel) SetArn(v string) *Channel { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *Channel) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *Channel { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *Channel) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *Channel { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *Channel) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *Channel { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *Channel) SetId(v string) *Channel { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *Channel) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *Channel { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *Channel) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *Channel { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *Channel) SetLogLevel(v string) *Channel { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *Channel) SetName(v string) *Channel { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *Channel) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *Channel { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *Channel) SetRoleArn(v string) *Channel { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *Channel) SetState(v string) *Channel { s.State = &v return s } type ChannelEgressEndpoint struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Public IP of where a channel's output comes from SourceIp *string `locationName:"sourceIp" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ChannelEgressEndpoint) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ChannelEgressEndpoint) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSourceIp sets the SourceIp field's value. func (s *ChannelEgressEndpoint) SetSourceIp(v string) *ChannelEgressEndpoint { s.SourceIp = &v return s } type ChannelSummary struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique arn of the channel. Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is onedestination // per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there isone destination per // packager. Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` // The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` // The unique id of the channel. Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` // List of input attachments for channel. InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` // The name of the channel. (user-mutable) Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // The number of currently healthy pipelines. PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel. RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ChannelSummary) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ChannelSummary) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetArn(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *ChannelSummary { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *ChannelSummary { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetId(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *ChannelSummary { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *ChannelSummary { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetLogLevel(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetName(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *ChannelSummary { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetRoleArn(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *ChannelSummary) SetState(v string) *ChannelSummary { s.State = &v return s } type CreateChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"` Reserved *string `locationName:"reserved" deprecated:"true" type:"string"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateChannelInput"} if s.EncoderSettings != nil { if err := s.EncoderSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("EncoderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.InputAttachments != nil { for i, v := range s.InputAttachments { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputAttachments", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *CreateChannelInput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *CreateChannelInput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *CreateChannelInput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *CreateChannelInput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetLogLevel(v string) *CreateChannelInput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetName(v string) *CreateChannelInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetRequestId(v string) *CreateChannelInput { s.RequestId = &v return s } // SetReserved sets the Reserved field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetReserved(v string) *CreateChannelInput { s.Reserved = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateChannelInput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } type CreateChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Channel *Channel `locationName:"channel" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetChannel sets the Channel field's value. func (s *CreateChannelOutput) SetChannel(v *Channel) *CreateChannelOutput { s.Channel = v return s } type CreateInputInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Destinations []*InputDestinationRequest `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` InputSecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"` MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlowRequest `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` Sources []*InputSourceRequest `locationName:"sources" type:"list"` Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInputInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInputInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestinationRequest) *CreateInputInput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateInputInput { s.InputSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlowRequest) *CreateInputInput { s.MediaConnectFlows = v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetName(v string) *CreateInputInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetRequestId(v string) *CreateInputInput { s.RequestId = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateInputInput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetSources sets the Sources field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetSources(v []*InputSourceRequest) *CreateInputInput { s.Sources = v return s } // SetType sets the Type field's value. func (s *CreateInputInput) SetType(v string) *CreateInputInput { s.Type = &v return s } type CreateInputOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Input *Input `locationName:"input" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInputOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInputOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInput sets the Input field's value. func (s *CreateInputOutput) SetInput(v *Input) *CreateInputOutput { s.Input = v return s } type CreateInputSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value. func (s *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr) *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput { s.WhitelistRules = v return s } type CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An Input Security Group SecurityGroup *InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"securityGroup" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSecurityGroup sets the SecurityGroup field's value. func (s *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetSecurityGroup(v *InputSecurityGroup) *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.SecurityGroup = v return s } type DeleteChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteChannelInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DeleteChannelInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } type DeleteChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput { s.State = &v return s } type DeleteInputInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // InputId is a required field InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteInputInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteInputInput"} if s.InputId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId")) } if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputId sets the InputId field's value. func (s *DeleteInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *DeleteInputInput { s.InputId = &v return s } type DeleteInputOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // InputSecurityGroupId is a required field InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput"} if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId")) } if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value. func (s *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput { s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v return s } type DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteReservationInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ReservationId is a required field ReservationId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"reservationId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteReservationInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteReservationInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteReservationInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteReservationInput"} if s.ReservationId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservationId")) } if s.ReservationId != nil && len(*s.ReservationId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ReservationId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationInput) SetReservationId(v string) *DeleteReservationInput { s.ReservationId = &v return s } type DeleteReservationOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"` CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"` Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"` End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"` FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"` OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"` // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"` Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"` ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"` // Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...) ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"` Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"` // Current reservation state State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"` UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteReservationOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteReservationOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetArn(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCount sets the Count field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetCount(v int64) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Count = &v return s } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.DurationUnits = &v return s } // SetEnd sets the End field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetEnd(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.End = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetName(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.OfferingDescription = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Region = &v return s } // SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetReservationId(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.ReservationId = &v return s } // SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.ResourceSpecification = v return s } // SetStart sets the Start field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetStart(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.Start = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetState(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.State = &v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DeleteReservationOutput { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } type DescribeChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeChannelInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DescribeChannelInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } type DescribeChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput { s.State = &v return s } type DescribeInputInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // InputId is a required field InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeInputInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeInputInput"} if s.InputId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId")) } if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputId sets the InputId field's value. func (s *DescribeInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *DescribeInputInput { s.InputId = &v return s } type DescribeInputOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` AttachedChannels []*string `locationName:"attachedChannels" type:"list"` Destinations []*InputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlow `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` SecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"securityGroups" type:"list"` Sources []*InputSource `locationName:"sources" type:"list"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputState"` Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachedChannels sets the AttachedChannels field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetAttachedChannels(v []*string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.AttachedChannels = v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestination) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlow) *DescribeInputOutput { s.MediaConnectFlows = v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetSecurityGroups sets the SecurityGroups field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetSecurityGroups(v []*string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.SecurityGroups = v return s } // SetSources sets the Sources field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetSources(v []*InputSource) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Sources = v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.State = &v return s } // SetType sets the Type field's value. func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetType(v string) *DescribeInputOutput { s.Type = &v return s } type DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // InputSecurityGroupId is a required field InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput"} if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId")) } if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput { s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v return s } type DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` Inputs []*string `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputSecurityGroupState"` WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRule `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetInputs(v []*string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.Inputs = v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.State = &v return s } // SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value. func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRule) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.WhitelistRules = v return s } type DescribeOfferingInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // OfferingId is a required field OfferingId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"offeringId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeOfferingInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeOfferingInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeOfferingInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOfferingInput"} if s.OfferingId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OfferingId")) } if s.OfferingId != nil && len(*s.OfferingId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OfferingId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingInput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeOfferingInput { s.OfferingId = &v return s } type DescribeOfferingOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"` Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"` FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"` OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"` OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"` // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"` Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"` // Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...) ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"` UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeOfferingOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeOfferingOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.DurationUnits = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.OfferingDescription = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.Region = &v return s } // SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.ResourceSpecification = v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DescribeOfferingOutput { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } type DescribeReservationInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ReservationId is a required field ReservationId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"reservationId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservationInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservationInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeReservationInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservationInput"} if s.ReservationId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservationId")) } if s.ReservationId != nil && len(*s.ReservationId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ReservationId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationInput) SetReservationId(v string) *DescribeReservationInput { s.ReservationId = &v return s } type DescribeReservationOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"` CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"` Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"` End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"` FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"` OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"` // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"` Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"` ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"` // Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...) ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"` Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"` // Current reservation state State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"` UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservationOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservationOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCount sets the Count field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetCount(v int64) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Count = &v return s } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.DurationUnits = &v return s } // SetEnd sets the End field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetEnd(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.End = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.OfferingDescription = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Region = &v return s } // SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetReservationId(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.ReservationId = &v return s } // SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.ResourceSpecification = v return s } // SetStart sets the Start field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetStart(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.Start = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.State = &v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DescribeReservationOutput { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } type DescribeScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeScheduleInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DescribeScheduleInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *DescribeScheduleInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetNextToken(v string) *DescribeScheduleInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type DescribeScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *DescribeScheduleOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *DescribeScheduleOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } // SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value. func (s *DescribeScheduleOutput) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *DescribeScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleActions = v return s } // DVB Network Information Table (NIT) type DvbNitSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The numeric value placed in the Network Information Table (NIT). // // NetworkId is a required field NetworkId *int64 `locationName:"networkId" type:"integer" required:"true"` // The network name text placed in the networkNameDescriptor inside the Network // Information Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. // // NetworkName is a required field NetworkName *string `locationName:"networkName" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"25" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DvbNitSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DvbNitSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DvbNitSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbNitSettings"} if s.NetworkId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NetworkId")) } if s.NetworkName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NetworkName")) } if s.NetworkName != nil && len(*s.NetworkName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NetworkName", 1)) } if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 25 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 25)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetNetworkId sets the NetworkId field's value. func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetNetworkId(v int64) *DvbNitSettings { s.NetworkId = &v return s } // SetNetworkName sets the NetworkName field's value. func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetNetworkName(v string) *DvbNitSettings { s.NetworkName = &v return s } // SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value. func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbNitSettings { s.RepInterval = &v return s } // DVB Service Description Table (SDT) type DvbSdtSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Selects method of inserting SDT information into output stream. The sdtFollow // setting copies SDT information from input stream to output stream. The sdtFollowIfPresent // setting copies SDT information from input stream to output stream if SDT // information is present in the input, otherwise it will fall back on the user-defined // values. The sdtManual setting means user will enter the SDT information. // The sdtNone setting means output stream will not contain SDT information. OutputSdt *string `locationName:"outputSdt" type:"string" enum:"DvbSdtOutputSdt"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"25" type:"integer"` // The service name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service Description // Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. ServiceName *string `locationName:"serviceName" min:"1" type:"string"` // The service provider name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service // Description Table. Maximum length is 256 characters. ServiceProviderName *string `locationName:"serviceProviderName" min:"1" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DvbSdtSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DvbSdtSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DvbSdtSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSdtSettings"} if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 25 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 25)) } if s.ServiceName != nil && len(*s.ServiceName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceName", 1)) } if s.ServiceProviderName != nil && len(*s.ServiceProviderName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceProviderName", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetOutputSdt sets the OutputSdt field's value. func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetOutputSdt(v string) *DvbSdtSettings { s.OutputSdt = &v return s } // SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value. func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbSdtSettings { s.RepInterval = &v return s } // SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value. func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetServiceName(v string) *DvbSdtSettings { s.ServiceName = &v return s } // SetServiceProviderName sets the ServiceProviderName field's value. func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetServiceProviderName(v string) *DvbSdtSettings { s.ServiceProviderName = &v return s } type DvbSubDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered // will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting // a left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If // x and y positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter, // the font will be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates. // Selecting "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify // pre-recorded subtitles. This option is not valid for source captions that // are STL or 608/embedded. These source settings are already pre-defined by // the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Alignment *string `locationName:"alignment" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationAlignment"` // Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundColor *string `locationName:"backgroundColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. // Leaving this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. BackgroundOpacity *int64 `locationName:"backgroundOpacity" type:"integer"` // External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf' // or 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types // of input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system. // Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display // of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. Font *InputLocation `locationName:"font" type:"structure"` // Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for // source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. FontColor *string `locationName:"fontColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationFontColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontOpacity *int64 `locationName:"fontOpacity" type:"integer"` // Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and // DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontResolution *int64 `locationName:"fontResolution" min:"96" type:"integer"` // When set to auto fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output. // Giving a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. FontSize *string `locationName:"fontSize" type:"string"` // Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions // that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already // pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings // must match. OutlineColor *string `locationName:"outlineColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor"` // Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source // captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings // are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font // settings must match. OutlineSize *int64 `locationName:"outlineSize" type:"integer"` // Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub // font settings must match. ShadowColor *string `locationName:"shadowColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationShadowColor"` // Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving // this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowOpacity *int64 `locationName:"shadowOpacity" type:"integer"` // Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in // pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowXOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowXOffset" type:"integer"` // Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels. // A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. ShadowYOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowYOffset" type:"integer"` // Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles // bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs. TeletextGridControl *string `locationName:"teletextGridControl" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl"` // Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side // of the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting // 10 pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided, // the horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter. // This option is not valid for source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or // teletext. These source settings are already pre-defined by the caption stream. // All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. XPosition *int64 `locationName:"xPosition" type:"integer"` // Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the // output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10 // pixels from the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided, // the caption will be positioned towards the bottom of the output. This option // is not valid for source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. // These source settings are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All // burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match. YPosition *int64 `locationName:"yPosition" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DvbSubDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DvbSubDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSubDestinationSettings"} if s.FontResolution != nil && *s.FontResolution < 96 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FontResolution", 96)) } if s.Font != nil { if err := s.Font.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Font", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAlignment sets the Alignment field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetAlignment(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.Alignment = &v return s } // SetBackgroundColor sets the BackgroundColor field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.BackgroundColor = &v return s } // SetBackgroundOpacity sets the BackgroundOpacity field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.BackgroundOpacity = &v return s } // SetFont sets the Font field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFont(v *InputLocation) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.Font = v return s } // SetFontColor sets the FontColor field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.FontColor = &v return s } // SetFontOpacity sets the FontOpacity field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.FontOpacity = &v return s } // SetFontResolution sets the FontResolution field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontResolution(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.FontResolution = &v return s } // SetFontSize sets the FontSize field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontSize(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.FontSize = &v return s } // SetOutlineColor sets the OutlineColor field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetOutlineColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.OutlineColor = &v return s } // SetOutlineSize sets the OutlineSize field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetOutlineSize(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.OutlineSize = &v return s } // SetShadowColor sets the ShadowColor field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.ShadowColor = &v return s } // SetShadowOpacity sets the ShadowOpacity field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.ShadowOpacity = &v return s } // SetShadowXOffset sets the ShadowXOffset field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowXOffset(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.ShadowXOffset = &v return s } // SetShadowYOffset sets the ShadowYOffset field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowYOffset(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.ShadowYOffset = &v return s } // SetTeletextGridControl sets the TeletextGridControl field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetTeletextGridControl(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.TeletextGridControl = &v return s } // SetXPosition sets the XPosition field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetXPosition(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.XPosition = &v return s } // SetYPosition sets the YPosition field's value. func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetYPosition(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings { s.YPosition = &v return s } type DvbSubSourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When using DVB-Sub with Burn-In or SMPTE-TT, use this PID for the source // content. Unused for DVB-Sub passthrough. All DVB-Sub content is passed through, // regardless of selectors. Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DvbSubSourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DvbSubSourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DvbSubSourceSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSubSourceSettings"} if s.Pid != nil && *s.Pid < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Pid", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPid sets the Pid field's value. func (s *DvbSubSourceSettings) SetPid(v int64) *DvbSubSourceSettings { s.Pid = &v return s } // DVB Time and Date Table (SDT) type DvbTdtSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"1000" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DvbTdtSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DvbTdtSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DvbTdtSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbTdtSettings"} if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 1000)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value. func (s *DvbTdtSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbTdtSettings { s.RepInterval = &v return s } type Eac3Settings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When set to attenuate3Db, applies a 3 dB attenuation to the surround channels. // Only used for 3/2 coding mode. AttenuationControl *string `locationName:"attenuationControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3AttenuationControl"` // Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode. Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"` // Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted E-AC-3 stream. See ATSC // A/52-2012 (Annex E) for background on these values. BitstreamMode *string `locationName:"bitstreamMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3BitstreamMode"` // Dolby Digital Plus coding mode. Determines number of channels. CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3CodingMode"` // When set to enabled, activates a DC highpass filter for all input channels. DcFilter *string `locationName:"dcFilter" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DcFilter"` // Sets the dialnorm for the output. If blank and input audio is Dolby Digital // Plus, dialnorm will be passed through. Dialnorm *int64 `locationName:"dialnorm" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Sets the Dolby dynamic range compression profile. DrcLine *string `locationName:"drcLine" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DrcLine"` // Sets the profile for heavy Dolby dynamic range compression, ensures that // the instantaneous signal peaks do not exceed specified levels. DrcRf *string `locationName:"drcRf" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DrcRf"` // When encoding 3/2 audio, setting to lfe enables the LFE channel LfeControl *string `locationName:"lfeControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3LfeControl"` // When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior // to encoding. Only valid with codingMode32 coding mode. LfeFilter *string `locationName:"lfeFilter" type:"string" enum:"Eac3LfeFilter"` // Left only/Right only center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LoRoCenterMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"loRoCenterMixLevel" type:"double"` // Left only/Right only surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LoRoSurroundMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"loRoSurroundMixLevel" type:"double"` // Left total/Right total center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LtRtCenterMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"ltRtCenterMixLevel" type:"double"` // Left total/Right total surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. LtRtSurroundMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"ltRtSurroundMixLevel" type:"double"` // When set to followInput, encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD, DD+, // or DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied // from one of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used. MetadataControl *string `locationName:"metadataControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3MetadataControl"` // When set to whenPossible, input DD+ audio will be passed through if it is // present on the input. This detection is dynamic over the life of the transcode. // Inputs that alternate between DD+ and non-DD+ content will have a consistent // DD+ output as the system alternates between passthrough and encoding. PassthroughControl *string `locationName:"passthroughControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3PassthroughControl"` // When set to shift90Degrees, applies a 90-degree phase shift to the surround // channels. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. PhaseControl *string `locationName:"phaseControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3PhaseControl"` // Stereo downmix preference. Only used for 3/2 coding mode. StereoDownmix *string `locationName:"stereoDownmix" type:"string" enum:"Eac3StereoDownmix"` // When encoding 3/2 audio, sets whether an extra center back surround channel // is matrix encoded into the left and right surround channels. SurroundExMode *string `locationName:"surroundExMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3SurroundExMode"` // When encoding 2/0 audio, sets whether Dolby Surround is matrix encoded into // the two channels. SurroundMode *string `locationName:"surroundMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3SurroundMode"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Eac3Settings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Eac3Settings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Eac3Settings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Eac3Settings"} if s.Dialnorm != nil && *s.Dialnorm < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Dialnorm", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAttenuationControl sets the AttenuationControl field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetAttenuationControl(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.AttenuationControl = &v return s } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Eac3Settings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetBitstreamMode sets the BitstreamMode field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetBitstreamMode(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.BitstreamMode = &v return s } // SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.CodingMode = &v return s } // SetDcFilter sets the DcFilter field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDcFilter(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.DcFilter = &v return s } // SetDialnorm sets the Dialnorm field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDialnorm(v int64) *Eac3Settings { s.Dialnorm = &v return s } // SetDrcLine sets the DrcLine field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDrcLine(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.DrcLine = &v return s } // SetDrcRf sets the DrcRf field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDrcRf(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.DrcRf = &v return s } // SetLfeControl sets the LfeControl field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLfeControl(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.LfeControl = &v return s } // SetLfeFilter sets the LfeFilter field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLfeFilter(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.LfeFilter = &v return s } // SetLoRoCenterMixLevel sets the LoRoCenterMixLevel field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLoRoCenterMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings { s.LoRoCenterMixLevel = &v return s } // SetLoRoSurroundMixLevel sets the LoRoSurroundMixLevel field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLoRoSurroundMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings { s.LoRoSurroundMixLevel = &v return s } // SetLtRtCenterMixLevel sets the LtRtCenterMixLevel field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLtRtCenterMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings { s.LtRtCenterMixLevel = &v return s } // SetLtRtSurroundMixLevel sets the LtRtSurroundMixLevel field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLtRtSurroundMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings { s.LtRtSurroundMixLevel = &v return s } // SetMetadataControl sets the MetadataControl field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetMetadataControl(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.MetadataControl = &v return s } // SetPassthroughControl sets the PassthroughControl field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetPassthroughControl(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.PassthroughControl = &v return s } // SetPhaseControl sets the PhaseControl field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetPhaseControl(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.PhaseControl = &v return s } // SetStereoDownmix sets the StereoDownmix field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetStereoDownmix(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.StereoDownmix = &v return s } // SetSurroundExMode sets the SurroundExMode field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetSurroundExMode(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.SurroundExMode = &v return s } // SetSurroundMode sets the SurroundMode field's value. func (s *Eac3Settings) SetSurroundMode(v string) *Eac3Settings { s.SurroundMode = &v return s } type EmbeddedDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type EmbeddedSourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility // bytes" fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data // present in the source content will be discarded. Convert608To708 *string `locationName:"convert608To708" type:"string" enum:"EmbeddedConvert608To708"` // Set to "auto" to handle streams with intermittent and/or non-aligned SCTE-20 // and Embedded captions. Scte20Detection *string `locationName:"scte20Detection" type:"string" enum:"EmbeddedScte20Detection"` // Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to // extract captions. Unused for passthrough. Source608ChannelNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608ChannelNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"` // This field is unused and deprecated. Source608TrackNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608TrackNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedSourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EmbeddedSourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EmbeddedSourceSettings"} if s.Source608ChannelNumber != nil && *s.Source608ChannelNumber < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608ChannelNumber", 1)) } if s.Source608TrackNumber != nil && *s.Source608TrackNumber < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608TrackNumber", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetConvert608To708 sets the Convert608To708 field's value. func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetConvert608To708(v string) *EmbeddedSourceSettings { s.Convert608To708 = &v return s } // SetScte20Detection sets the Scte20Detection field's value. func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetScte20Detection(v string) *EmbeddedSourceSettings { s.Scte20Detection = &v return s } // SetSource608ChannelNumber sets the Source608ChannelNumber field's value. func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetSource608ChannelNumber(v int64) *EmbeddedSourceSettings { s.Source608ChannelNumber = &v return s } // SetSource608TrackNumber sets the Source608TrackNumber field's value. func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetSource608TrackNumber(v int64) *EmbeddedSourceSettings { s.Source608TrackNumber = &v return s } type EncoderSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // AudioDescriptions is a required field AudioDescriptions []*AudioDescription `locationName:"audioDescriptions" type:"list" required:"true"` // Settings for ad avail blanking. AvailBlanking *AvailBlanking `locationName:"availBlanking" type:"structure"` // Event-wide configuration settings for ad avail insertion. AvailConfiguration *AvailConfiguration `locationName:"availConfiguration" type:"structure"` // Settings for blackout slate. BlackoutSlate *BlackoutSlate `locationName:"blackoutSlate" type:"structure"` // Settings for caption decriptions CaptionDescriptions []*CaptionDescription `locationName:"captionDescriptions" type:"list"` // Configuration settings that apply to the event as a whole. GlobalConfiguration *GlobalConfiguration `locationName:"globalConfiguration" type:"structure"` // OutputGroups is a required field OutputGroups []*OutputGroup `locationName:"outputGroups" type:"list" required:"true"` // Contains settings used to acquire and adjust timecode information from inputs. // // TimecodeConfig is a required field TimecodeConfig *TimecodeConfig `locationName:"timecodeConfig" type:"structure" required:"true"` // VideoDescriptions is a required field VideoDescriptions []*VideoDescription `locationName:"videoDescriptions" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EncoderSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EncoderSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *EncoderSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EncoderSettings"} if s.AudioDescriptions == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AudioDescriptions")) } if s.OutputGroups == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputGroups")) } if s.TimecodeConfig == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TimecodeConfig")) } if s.VideoDescriptions == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VideoDescriptions")) } if s.AudioDescriptions != nil { for i, v := range s.AudioDescriptions { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "AudioDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if s.AvailBlanking != nil { if err := s.AvailBlanking.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AvailBlanking", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.AvailConfiguration != nil { if err := s.AvailConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AvailConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.BlackoutSlate != nil { if err := s.BlackoutSlate.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("BlackoutSlate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.CaptionDescriptions != nil { for i, v := range s.CaptionDescriptions { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if s.GlobalConfiguration != nil { if err := s.GlobalConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("GlobalConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.OutputGroups != nil { for i, v := range s.OutputGroups { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "OutputGroups", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if s.TimecodeConfig != nil { if err := s.TimecodeConfig.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("TimecodeConfig", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.VideoDescriptions != nil { for i, v := range s.VideoDescriptions { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "VideoDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioDescriptions sets the AudioDescriptions field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAudioDescriptions(v []*AudioDescription) *EncoderSettings { s.AudioDescriptions = v return s } // SetAvailBlanking sets the AvailBlanking field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAvailBlanking(v *AvailBlanking) *EncoderSettings { s.AvailBlanking = v return s } // SetAvailConfiguration sets the AvailConfiguration field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAvailConfiguration(v *AvailConfiguration) *EncoderSettings { s.AvailConfiguration = v return s } // SetBlackoutSlate sets the BlackoutSlate field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetBlackoutSlate(v *BlackoutSlate) *EncoderSettings { s.BlackoutSlate = v return s } // SetCaptionDescriptions sets the CaptionDescriptions field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetCaptionDescriptions(v []*CaptionDescription) *EncoderSettings { s.CaptionDescriptions = v return s } // SetGlobalConfiguration sets the GlobalConfiguration field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetGlobalConfiguration(v *GlobalConfiguration) *EncoderSettings { s.GlobalConfiguration = v return s } // SetOutputGroups sets the OutputGroups field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetOutputGroups(v []*OutputGroup) *EncoderSettings { s.OutputGroups = v return s } // SetTimecodeConfig sets the TimecodeConfig field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetTimecodeConfig(v *TimecodeConfig) *EncoderSettings { s.TimecodeConfig = v return s } // SetVideoDescriptions sets the VideoDescriptions field's value. func (s *EncoderSettings) SetVideoDescriptions(v []*VideoDescription) *EncoderSettings { s.VideoDescriptions = v return s } type FecOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Parameter D from SMPTE 2022-1. The height of the FEC protection matrix. The // number of transport stream packets per column error correction packet. Must // be between 4 and 20, inclusive. ColumnDepth *int64 `locationName:"columnDepth" min:"4" type:"integer"` // Enables column only or column and row based FEC IncludeFec *string `locationName:"includeFec" type:"string" enum:"FecOutputIncludeFec"` // Parameter L from SMPTE 2022-1. The width of the FEC protection matrix. Must // be between 1 and 20, inclusive. If only Column FEC is used, then larger values // increase robustness. If Row FEC is used, then this is the number of transport // stream packets per row error correction packet, and the value must be between // 4 and 20, inclusive, if includeFec is columnAndRow. If includeFec is column, // this value must be 1 to 20, inclusive. RowLength *int64 `locationName:"rowLength" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FecOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FecOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *FecOutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FecOutputSettings"} if s.ColumnDepth != nil && *s.ColumnDepth < 4 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ColumnDepth", 4)) } if s.RowLength != nil && *s.RowLength < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RowLength", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetColumnDepth sets the ColumnDepth field's value. func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetColumnDepth(v int64) *FecOutputSettings { s.ColumnDepth = &v return s } // SetIncludeFec sets the IncludeFec field's value. func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetIncludeFec(v string) *FecOutputSettings { s.IncludeFec = &v return s } // SetRowLength sets the RowLength field's value. func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetRowLength(v int64) *FecOutputSettings { s.RowLength = &v return s } // Start time for the action. type FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Start time for the action to start in the channel. (Not the time for the // action to be added to the schedule: actions are always added to the schedule // immediately.) UTC format: yyyy-mm-ddThh:mm:ss.nnnZ. All the letters are digits // (for example, mm might be 01) except for the two constants "T" for time and // "Z" for "UTC format". // // Time is a required field Time *string `locationName:"time" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings"} if s.Time == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Time")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetTime sets the Time field's value. func (s *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetTime(v string) *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings { s.Time = &v return s } // Settings to specify if an action follows another. type FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Identifies whether this action starts relative to the start or relative to // the end of the reference action. // // FollowPoint is a required field FollowPoint *string `locationName:"followPoint" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"FollowPoint"` // The action name of another action that this one refers to. // // ReferenceActionName is a required field ReferenceActionName *string `locationName:"referenceActionName" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings"} if s.FollowPoint == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FollowPoint")) } if s.ReferenceActionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReferenceActionName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetFollowPoint sets the FollowPoint field's value. func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFollowPoint(v string) *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings { s.FollowPoint = &v return s } // SetReferenceActionName sets the ReferenceActionName field's value. func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetReferenceActionName(v string) *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings { s.ReferenceActionName = &v return s } // Frame Capture Group Settings type FrameCaptureGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The destination for the frame capture files. Either the URI for an Amazon // S3 bucket and object, plus a file name prefix (for example, s3ssl://sportsDelivery/highlights/20180820/curling_) // or the URI for a MediaStore container, plus a file name prefix (for example, // mediastoressl://sportsDelivery/20180820/curling_). The final file names consist // of the prefix from the destination field (for example, "curling_") + name // modifier + the counter (5 digits, starting from 00001) + extension (which // is always .jpg). For example, curlingLow.00001.jpg // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *FrameCaptureGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FrameCaptureGroupSettings"} if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *FrameCaptureGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *FrameCaptureGroupSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // Frame Capture Output Settings type FrameCaptureOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Required if the output group contains more than one output. This modifier // forms part of the output file name. NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value. func (s *FrameCaptureOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *FrameCaptureOutputSettings { s.NameModifier = &v return s } // Frame Capture Settings type FrameCaptureSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The frequency, in seconds, for capturing frames for inclusion in the output. // For example, "10" means capture a frame every 10 seconds. // // CaptureInterval is a required field CaptureInterval *int64 `locationName:"captureInterval" min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s FrameCaptureSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *FrameCaptureSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FrameCaptureSettings"} if s.CaptureInterval == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CaptureInterval")) } if s.CaptureInterval != nil && *s.CaptureInterval < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("CaptureInterval", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCaptureInterval sets the CaptureInterval field's value. func (s *FrameCaptureSettings) SetCaptureInterval(v int64) *FrameCaptureSettings { s.CaptureInterval = &v return s } type GlobalConfiguration struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Value to set the initial audio gain for the Live Event. InitialAudioGain *int64 `locationName:"initialAudioGain" type:"integer"` // Indicates the action to take when the current input completes (e.g. end-of-file). // When switchAndLoopInputs is configured the encoder will restart at the beginning // of the first input. When "none" is configured the encoder will transcode // either black, a solid color, or a user specified slate images per the "Input // Loss Behavior" configuration until the next input switch occurs (which is // controlled through the Channel Schedule API). InputEndAction *string `locationName:"inputEndAction" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction"` // Settings for system actions when input is lost. InputLossBehavior *InputLossBehavior `locationName:"inputLossBehavior" type:"structure"` // Indicates whether the rate of frames emitted by the Live encoder should be // paced by its system clock (which optionally may be locked to another source // via NTP) or should be locked to the clock of the source that is providing // the input stream. OutputTimingSource *string `locationName:"outputTimingSource" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource"` // Adjusts video input buffer for streams with very low video framerates. This // is commonly set to enabled for music channels with less than one video frame // per second. SupportLowFramerateInputs *string `locationName:"supportLowFramerateInputs" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GlobalConfiguration) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GlobalConfiguration) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GlobalConfiguration"} if s.InitialAudioGain != nil && *s.InitialAudioGain < -60 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("InitialAudioGain", -60)) } if s.InputLossBehavior != nil { if err := s.InputLossBehavior.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("InputLossBehavior", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInitialAudioGain sets the InitialAudioGain field's value. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInitialAudioGain(v int64) *GlobalConfiguration { s.InitialAudioGain = &v return s } // SetInputEndAction sets the InputEndAction field's value. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInputEndAction(v string) *GlobalConfiguration { s.InputEndAction = &v return s } // SetInputLossBehavior sets the InputLossBehavior field's value. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInputLossBehavior(v *InputLossBehavior) *GlobalConfiguration { s.InputLossBehavior = v return s } // SetOutputTimingSource sets the OutputTimingSource field's value. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetOutputTimingSource(v string) *GlobalConfiguration { s.OutputTimingSource = &v return s } // SetSupportLowFramerateInputs sets the SupportLowFramerateInputs field's value. func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetSupportLowFramerateInputs(v string) *GlobalConfiguration { s.SupportLowFramerateInputs = &v return s } type H264Settings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Adaptive quantization. Allows intra-frame quantizers to vary to improve visual // quality. AdaptiveQuantization *string `locationName:"adaptiveQuantization" type:"string" enum:"H264AdaptiveQuantization"` // Indicates that AFD values will be written into the output stream. If afdSignaling // is "auto", the system will try to preserve the input AFD value (in cases // where multiple AFD values are valid). If set to "fixed", the AFD value will // be the value configured in the fixedAfd parameter. AfdSignaling *string `locationName:"afdSignaling" type:"string" enum:"AfdSignaling"` // Average bitrate in bits/second. Required when the rate control mode is VBR // or CBR. Not used for QVBR. In an MS Smooth output group, each output must // have a unique value when its bitrate is rounded down to the nearest multiple // of 1000. Bitrate *int64 `locationName:"bitrate" min:"1000" type:"integer"` // Percentage of the buffer that should initially be filled (HRD buffer model). BufFillPct *int64 `locationName:"bufFillPct" type:"integer"` // Size of buffer (HRD buffer model) in bits/second. BufSize *int64 `locationName:"bufSize" type:"integer"` // Includes colorspace metadata in the output. ColorMetadata *string `locationName:"colorMetadata" type:"string" enum:"H264ColorMetadata"` // Entropy encoding mode. Use cabac (must be in Main or High profile) or cavlc. EntropyEncoding *string `locationName:"entropyEncoding" type:"string" enum:"H264EntropyEncoding"` // Four bit AFD value to write on all frames of video in the output stream. // Only valid when afdSignaling is set to 'Fixed'. FixedAfd *string `locationName:"fixedAfd" type:"string" enum:"FixedAfd"` // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame to reduce flicker // or 'pop' on I-frames. FlickerAq *string `locationName:"flickerAq" type:"string" enum:"H264FlickerAq"` // This field indicates how the output video frame rate is specified. If "specified" // is selected then the output video frame rate is determined by framerateNumerator // and framerateDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is selected then // the output video frame rate will be set equal to the input video frame rate // of the first input. FramerateControl *string `locationName:"framerateControl" type:"string" enum:"H264FramerateControl"` // Framerate denominator. FramerateDenominator *int64 `locationName:"framerateDenominator" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Framerate numerator - framerate is a fraction, e.g. 24000 / 1001 = 23.976 // fps. FramerateNumerator *int64 `locationName:"framerateNumerator" min:"1" type:"integer"` // If enabled, use reference B frames for GOP structures that have B frames // > 1. GopBReference *string `locationName:"gopBReference" type:"string" enum:"H264GopBReference"` // Frequency of closed GOPs. In streaming applications, it is recommended that // this be set to 1 so a decoder joining mid-stream will receive an IDR frame // as quickly as possible. Setting this value to 0 will break output segmenting. GopClosedCadence *int64 `locationName:"gopClosedCadence" type:"integer"` // Number of B-frames between reference frames. GopNumBFrames *int64 `locationName:"gopNumBFrames" type:"integer"` // GOP size (keyframe interval) in units of either frames or seconds per gopSizeUnits. // Must be greater than zero. GopSize *float64 `locationName:"gopSize" type:"double"` // Indicates if the gopSize is specified in frames or seconds. If seconds the // system will convert the gopSize into a frame count at run time. GopSizeUnits *string `locationName:"gopSizeUnits" type:"string" enum:"H264GopSizeUnits"` // H.264 Level. Level *string `locationName:"level" type:"string" enum:"H264Level"` // Amount of lookahead. A value of low can decrease latency and memory usage, // while high can produce better quality for certain content. LookAheadRateControl *string `locationName:"lookAheadRateControl" type:"string" enum:"H264LookAheadRateControl"` // For QVBR: See the tooltip for Quality level For VBR: Set the maximum bitrate // in order to accommodate expected spikes in the complexity of the video. MaxBitrate *int64 `locationName:"maxBitrate" min:"1000" type:"integer"` // Only meaningful if sceneChangeDetect is set to enabled. Enforces separation // between repeated (cadence) I-frames and I-frames inserted by Scene Change // Detection. If a scene change I-frame is within I-interval frames of a cadence // I-frame, the GOP is shrunk and/or stretched to the scene change I-frame. // GOP stretch requires enabling lookahead as well as setting I-interval. The // normal cadence resumes for the next GOP. Note: Maximum GOP stretch = GOP // size + Min-I-interval - 1 MinIInterval *int64 `locationName:"minIInterval" type:"integer"` // Number of reference frames to use. The encoder may use more than requested // if using B-frames and/or interlaced encoding. NumRefFrames *int64 `locationName:"numRefFrames" min:"1" type:"integer"` // This field indicates how the output pixel aspect ratio is specified. If "specified" // is selected then the output video pixel aspect ratio is determined by parNumerator // and parDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is selected then the output // pixsel aspect ratio will be set equal to the input video pixel aspect ratio // of the first input. ParControl *string `locationName:"parControl" type:"string" enum:"H264ParControl"` // Pixel Aspect Ratio denominator. ParDenominator *int64 `locationName:"parDenominator" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Pixel Aspect Ratio numerator. ParNumerator *int64 `locationName:"parNumerator" type:"integer"` // H.264 Profile. Profile *string `locationName:"profile" type:"string" enum:"H264Profile"` // Controls the target quality for the video encode. Applies only when the rate // control mode is QVBR. Set values for the QVBR quality level field and Max // bitrate field that suit your most important viewing devices. Recommended // values are:- Primary screen: Quality level: 8 to 10. Max bitrate: 4M- PC // or tablet: Quality level: 7. Max bitrate: 1.5M to 3M- Smartphone: Quality // level: 6. Max bitrate: 1M to 1.5M QvbrQualityLevel *int64 `locationName:"qvbrQualityLevel" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Rate control mode. QVBR: Quality will match the specified quality level except // when it is constrained by themaximum bitrate. Recommended if you or your // viewers pay for bandwidth.VBR: Quality and bitrate vary, depending on the // video complexity. Recommended instead of QVBRif you want to maintain a specific // average bitrate over the duration of the channel.CBR: Quality varies, depending // on the video complexity. Recommended only if you distributeyour assets to // devices that cannot handle variable bitrates. RateControlMode *string `locationName:"rateControlMode" type:"string" enum:"H264RateControlMode"` // Sets the scan type of the output to progressive or top-field-first interlaced. ScanType *string `locationName:"scanType" type:"string" enum:"H264ScanType"` // Scene change detection.- On: inserts I-frames when scene change is detected.- // Off: does not force an I-frame when scene change is detected. SceneChangeDetect *string `locationName:"sceneChangeDetect" type:"string" enum:"H264SceneChangeDetect"` // Number of slices per picture. Must be less than or equal to the number of // macroblock rows for progressive pictures, and less than or equal to half // the number of macroblock rows for interlaced pictures.This field is optional; // when no value is specified the encoder will choose the number of slices based // on encode resolution. Slices *int64 `locationName:"slices" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Softness. Selects quantizer matrix, larger values reduce high-frequency content // in the encoded image. Softness *int64 `locationName:"softness" type:"integer"` // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on spatial // variation of content complexity. SpatialAq *string `locationName:"spatialAq" type:"string" enum:"H264SpatialAq"` // If set to fixed, use gopNumBFrames B-frames per sub-GOP. If set to dynamic, // optimize the number of B-frames used for each sub-GOP to improve visual quality. SubgopLength *string `locationName:"subgopLength" type:"string" enum:"H264SubGopLength"` // Produces a bitstream compliant with SMPTE RP-2027. Syntax *string `locationName:"syntax" type:"string" enum:"H264Syntax"` // If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on temporal // variation of content complexity. TemporalAq *string `locationName:"temporalAq" type:"string" enum:"H264TemporalAq"` // Determines how timecodes should be inserted into the video elementary stream.- // 'disabled': Do not include timecodes- 'picTimingSei': Pass through picture // timing SEI messages from the source specified in Timecode Config TimecodeInsertion *string `locationName:"timecodeInsertion" type:"string" enum:"H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior"` } // String returns the string representation func (s H264Settings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s H264Settings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *H264Settings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "H264Settings"} if s.Bitrate != nil && *s.Bitrate < 1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Bitrate", 1000)) } if s.FramerateDenominator != nil && *s.FramerateDenominator < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FramerateDenominator", 1)) } if s.FramerateNumerator != nil && *s.FramerateNumerator < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FramerateNumerator", 1)) } if s.MaxBitrate != nil && *s.MaxBitrate < 1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxBitrate", 1000)) } if s.NumRefFrames != nil && *s.NumRefFrames < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("NumRefFrames", 1)) } if s.ParDenominator != nil && *s.ParDenominator < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ParDenominator", 1)) } if s.QvbrQualityLevel != nil && *s.QvbrQualityLevel < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("QvbrQualityLevel", 1)) } if s.Slices != nil && *s.Slices < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Slices", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdaptiveQuantization sets the AdaptiveQuantization field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetAdaptiveQuantization(v string) *H264Settings { s.AdaptiveQuantization = &v return s } // SetAfdSignaling sets the AfdSignaling field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetAfdSignaling(v string) *H264Settings { s.AfdSignaling = &v return s } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetBitrate(v int64) *H264Settings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetBufFillPct sets the BufFillPct field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetBufFillPct(v int64) *H264Settings { s.BufFillPct = &v return s } // SetBufSize sets the BufSize field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetBufSize(v int64) *H264Settings { s.BufSize = &v return s } // SetColorMetadata sets the ColorMetadata field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetColorMetadata(v string) *H264Settings { s.ColorMetadata = &v return s } // SetEntropyEncoding sets the EntropyEncoding field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetEntropyEncoding(v string) *H264Settings { s.EntropyEncoding = &v return s } // SetFixedAfd sets the FixedAfd field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetFixedAfd(v string) *H264Settings { s.FixedAfd = &v return s } // SetFlickerAq sets the FlickerAq field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetFlickerAq(v string) *H264Settings { s.FlickerAq = &v return s } // SetFramerateControl sets the FramerateControl field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateControl(v string) *H264Settings { s.FramerateControl = &v return s } // SetFramerateDenominator sets the FramerateDenominator field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateDenominator(v int64) *H264Settings { s.FramerateDenominator = &v return s } // SetFramerateNumerator sets the FramerateNumerator field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateNumerator(v int64) *H264Settings { s.FramerateNumerator = &v return s } // SetGopBReference sets the GopBReference field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetGopBReference(v string) *H264Settings { s.GopBReference = &v return s } // SetGopClosedCadence sets the GopClosedCadence field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetGopClosedCadence(v int64) *H264Settings { s.GopClosedCadence = &v return s } // SetGopNumBFrames sets the GopNumBFrames field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetGopNumBFrames(v int64) *H264Settings { s.GopNumBFrames = &v return s } // SetGopSize sets the GopSize field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetGopSize(v float64) *H264Settings { s.GopSize = &v return s } // SetGopSizeUnits sets the GopSizeUnits field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetGopSizeUnits(v string) *H264Settings { s.GopSizeUnits = &v return s } // SetLevel sets the Level field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetLevel(v string) *H264Settings { s.Level = &v return s } // SetLookAheadRateControl sets the LookAheadRateControl field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetLookAheadRateControl(v string) *H264Settings { s.LookAheadRateControl = &v return s } // SetMaxBitrate sets the MaxBitrate field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetMaxBitrate(v int64) *H264Settings { s.MaxBitrate = &v return s } // SetMinIInterval sets the MinIInterval field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetMinIInterval(v int64) *H264Settings { s.MinIInterval = &v return s } // SetNumRefFrames sets the NumRefFrames field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetNumRefFrames(v int64) *H264Settings { s.NumRefFrames = &v return s } // SetParControl sets the ParControl field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetParControl(v string) *H264Settings { s.ParControl = &v return s } // SetParDenominator sets the ParDenominator field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetParDenominator(v int64) *H264Settings { s.ParDenominator = &v return s } // SetParNumerator sets the ParNumerator field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetParNumerator(v int64) *H264Settings { s.ParNumerator = &v return s } // SetProfile sets the Profile field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetProfile(v string) *H264Settings { s.Profile = &v return s } // SetQvbrQualityLevel sets the QvbrQualityLevel field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetQvbrQualityLevel(v int64) *H264Settings { s.QvbrQualityLevel = &v return s } // SetRateControlMode sets the RateControlMode field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetRateControlMode(v string) *H264Settings { s.RateControlMode = &v return s } // SetScanType sets the ScanType field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetScanType(v string) *H264Settings { s.ScanType = &v return s } // SetSceneChangeDetect sets the SceneChangeDetect field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSceneChangeDetect(v string) *H264Settings { s.SceneChangeDetect = &v return s } // SetSlices sets the Slices field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSlices(v int64) *H264Settings { s.Slices = &v return s } // SetSoftness sets the Softness field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSoftness(v int64) *H264Settings { s.Softness = &v return s } // SetSpatialAq sets the SpatialAq field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSpatialAq(v string) *H264Settings { s.SpatialAq = &v return s } // SetSubgopLength sets the SubgopLength field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSubgopLength(v string) *H264Settings { s.SubgopLength = &v return s } // SetSyntax sets the Syntax field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetSyntax(v string) *H264Settings { s.Syntax = &v return s } // SetTemporalAq sets the TemporalAq field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetTemporalAq(v string) *H264Settings { s.TemporalAq = &v return s } // SetTimecodeInsertion sets the TimecodeInsertion field's value. func (s *H264Settings) SetTimecodeInsertion(v string) *H264Settings { s.TimecodeInsertion = &v return s } type HlsAkamaiSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection // is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"` // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"` // Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to Akamai. User should // contact Akamai to enable this feature. HttpTransferMode *string `locationName:"httpTransferMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode"` // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into // an error state. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` // Salt for authenticated Akamai. Salt *string `locationName:"salt" type:"string"` // Token parameter for authenticated akamai. If not specified, _gda_ is used. Token *string `locationName:"token" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsAkamaiSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsAkamaiSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.FilecacheDuration = &v return s } // SetHttpTransferMode sets the HttpTransferMode field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetHttpTransferMode(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.HttpTransferMode = &v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } // SetSalt sets the Salt field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetSalt(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.Salt = &v return s } // SetToken sets the Token field's value. func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetToken(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings { s.Token = &v return s } type HlsBasicPutSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection // is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"` // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"` // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into // an error state. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsBasicPutSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsBasicPutSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value. func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings { s.FilecacheDuration = &v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } type HlsCdnSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` HlsAkamaiSettings *HlsAkamaiSettings `locationName:"hlsAkamaiSettings" type:"structure"` HlsBasicPutSettings *HlsBasicPutSettings `locationName:"hlsBasicPutSettings" type:"structure"` HlsMediaStoreSettings *HlsMediaStoreSettings `locationName:"hlsMediaStoreSettings" type:"structure"` HlsWebdavSettings *HlsWebdavSettings `locationName:"hlsWebdavSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsCdnSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsCdnSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHlsAkamaiSettings sets the HlsAkamaiSettings field's value. func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsAkamaiSettings(v *HlsAkamaiSettings) *HlsCdnSettings { s.HlsAkamaiSettings = v return s } // SetHlsBasicPutSettings sets the HlsBasicPutSettings field's value. func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsBasicPutSettings(v *HlsBasicPutSettings) *HlsCdnSettings { s.HlsBasicPutSettings = v return s } // SetHlsMediaStoreSettings sets the HlsMediaStoreSettings field's value. func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsMediaStoreSettings(v *HlsMediaStoreSettings) *HlsCdnSettings { s.HlsMediaStoreSettings = v return s } // SetHlsWebdavSettings sets the HlsWebdavSettings field's value. func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsWebdavSettings(v *HlsWebdavSettings) *HlsCdnSettings { s.HlsWebdavSettings = v return s } type HlsGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Choose one or more ad marker types to pass SCTE35 signals through to this // group of Apple HLS outputs. AdMarkers []*string `locationName:"adMarkers" type:"list"` // A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8 // file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than // the main .m3u8 file. BaseUrlContent *string `locationName:"baseUrlContent" type:"string"` // A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8 // file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than // the main .m3u8 file. BaseUrlManifest *string `locationName:"baseUrlManifest" type:"string"` // Mapping of up to 4 caption channels to caption languages. Is only meaningful // if captionLanguageSetting is set to "insert". CaptionLanguageMappings []*CaptionLanguageMapping `locationName:"captionLanguageMappings" type:"list"` // Applies only to 608 Embedded output captions.insert: Include CLOSED-CAPTIONS // lines in the manifest. Specify at least one language in the CC1 Language // Code field. One CLOSED-CAPTION line is added for each Language Code you specify. // Make sure to specify the languages in the order in which they appear in the // original source (if the source is embedded format) or the order of the caption // selectors (if the source is other than embedded). Otherwise, languages in // the manifest will not match up properly with the output captions.none: Include // CLOSED-CAPTIONS=NONE line in the manifest.omit: Omit any CLOSED-CAPTIONS // line from the manifest. CaptionLanguageSetting *string `locationName:"captionLanguageSetting" type:"string" enum:"HlsCaptionLanguageSetting"` // When set to "disabled", sets the #EXT-X-ALLOW-CACHE:no tag in the manifest, // which prevents clients from saving media segments for later replay. ClientCache *string `locationName:"clientCache" type:"string" enum:"HlsClientCache"` // Specification to use (RFC-6381 or the default RFC-4281) during m3u8 playlist // generation. CodecSpecification *string `locationName:"codecSpecification" type:"string" enum:"HlsCodecSpecification"` // For use with encryptionType. This is a 128-bit, 16-byte hex value represented // by a 32-character text string. If ivSource is set to "explicit" then this // parameter is required and is used as the IV for encryption. ConstantIv *string `locationName:"constantIv" min:"32" type:"string"` // A directory or HTTP destination for the HLS segments, manifest files, and // encryption keys (if enabled). // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Place segments in subdirectories. DirectoryStructure *string `locationName:"directoryStructure" type:"string" enum:"HlsDirectoryStructure"` // Encrypts the segments with the given encryption scheme. Exclude this parameter // if no encryption is desired. EncryptionType *string `locationName:"encryptionType" type:"string" enum:"HlsEncryptionType"` // Parameters that control interactions with the CDN. HlsCdnSettings *HlsCdnSettings `locationName:"hlsCdnSettings" type:"structure"` // If enabled, writes out I-Frame only playlists in addition to media playlists. IFrameOnlyPlaylists *string `locationName:"iFrameOnlyPlaylists" type:"string" enum:"IFrameOnlyPlaylistType"` // If mode is "live", the number of segments to retain in the manifest (.m3u8) // file. This number must be less than or equal to keepSegments. If mode is // "vod", this parameter has no effect. IndexNSegments *int64 `locationName:"indexNSegments" min:"3" type:"integer"` // Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss. InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForHlsOut"` // For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit // number used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If set to // "include", IV is listed in the manifest, otherwise the IV is not in the manifest. IvInManifest *string `locationName:"ivInManifest" type:"string" enum:"HlsIvInManifest"` // For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit // number used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If this setting // is "followsSegmentNumber", it will cause the IV to change every segment (to // match the segment number). If this is set to "explicit", you must enter a // constantIv value. IvSource *string `locationName:"ivSource" type:"string" enum:"HlsIvSource"` // If mode is "live", the number of TS segments to retain in the destination // directory. If mode is "vod", this parameter has no effect. KeepSegments *int64 `locationName:"keepSegments" min:"1" type:"integer"` // The value specifies how the key is represented in the resource identified // by the URI. If parameter is absent, an implicit value of "identity" is used. // A reverse DNS string can also be given. KeyFormat *string `locationName:"keyFormat" type:"string"` // Either a single positive integer version value or a slash delimited list // of version values (1/2/3). KeyFormatVersions *string `locationName:"keyFormatVersions" type:"string"` // The key provider settings. KeyProviderSettings *KeyProviderSettings `locationName:"keyProviderSettings" type:"structure"` // When set to gzip, compresses HLS playlist. ManifestCompression *string `locationName:"manifestCompression" type:"string" enum:"HlsManifestCompression"` // Indicates whether the output manifest should use floating point or integer // values for segment duration. ManifestDurationFormat *string `locationName:"manifestDurationFormat" type:"string" enum:"HlsManifestDurationFormat"` // When set, minimumSegmentLength is enforced by looking ahead and back within // the specified range for a nearby avail and extending the segment size if // needed. MinSegmentLength *int64 `locationName:"minSegmentLength" type:"integer"` // If "vod", all segments are indexed and kept permanently in the destination // and manifest. If "live", only the number segments specified in keepSegments // and indexNSegments are kept; newer segments replace older segments, which // may prevent players from rewinding all the way to the beginning of the event.VOD // mode uses HLS EXT-X-PLAYLIST-TYPE of EVENT while the channel is running, // converting it to a "VOD" type manifest on completion of the stream. Mode *string `locationName:"mode" type:"string" enum:"HlsMode"` // Generates the .m3u8 playlist file for this HLS output group. The segmentsOnly // option will output segments without the .m3u8 file. OutputSelection *string `locationName:"outputSelection" type:"string" enum:"HlsOutputSelection"` // Includes or excludes EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME tag in .m3u8 manifest files. // The value is calculated as follows: either the program date and time are // initialized using the input timecode source, or the time is initialized using // the input timecode source and the date is initialized using the timestampOffset. ProgramDateTime *string `locationName:"programDateTime" type:"string" enum:"HlsProgramDateTime"` // Period of insertion of EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME entry, in seconds. ProgramDateTimePeriod *int64 `locationName:"programDateTimePeriod" type:"integer"` // When set to "enabled", includes the media playlists from both pipelines in // the master manifest (.m3u8) file. RedundantManifest *string `locationName:"redundantManifest" type:"string" enum:"HlsRedundantManifest"` // Length of MPEG-2 Transport Stream segments to create (in seconds). Note that // segments will end on the next keyframe after this number of seconds, so actual // segment length may be longer. SegmentLength *int64 `locationName:"segmentLength" min:"1" type:"integer"` // useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is // always used. SegmentationMode *string `locationName:"segmentationMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsSegmentationMode"` // Number of segments to write to a subdirectory before starting a new one. // directoryStructure must be subdirectoryPerStream for this setting to have // an effect. SegmentsPerSubdirectory *int64 `locationName:"segmentsPerSubdirectory" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Include or exclude RESOLUTION attribute for video in EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag // of variant manifest. StreamInfResolution *string `locationName:"streamInfResolution" type:"string" enum:"HlsStreamInfResolution"` // Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode. TimedMetadataId3Frame *string `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Frame" type:"string" enum:"HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame"` // Timed Metadata interval in seconds. TimedMetadataId3Period *int64 `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Period" type:"integer"` // Provides an extra millisecond delta offset to fine tune the timestamps. TimestampDeltaMilliseconds *int64 `locationName:"timestampDeltaMilliseconds" type:"integer"` // When set to "singleFile", emits the program as a single media resource (.ts) // file, and uses #EXT-X-BYTERANGE tags to index segment for playback. Playback // of VOD mode content during event is not guaranteed due to HTTP server caching. TsFileMode *string `locationName:"tsFileMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsTsFileMode"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsGroupSettings"} if s.ConstantIv != nil && len(*s.ConstantIv) < 32 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ConstantIv", 32)) } if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if s.IndexNSegments != nil && *s.IndexNSegments < 3 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("IndexNSegments", 3)) } if s.KeepSegments != nil && *s.KeepSegments < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("KeepSegments", 1)) } if s.SegmentLength != nil && *s.SegmentLength < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SegmentLength", 1)) } if s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory != nil && *s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SegmentsPerSubdirectory", 1)) } if s.CaptionLanguageMappings != nil { for i, v := range s.CaptionLanguageMappings { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionLanguageMappings", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if s.KeyProviderSettings != nil { if err := s.KeyProviderSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("KeyProviderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdMarkers sets the AdMarkers field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetAdMarkers(v []*string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.AdMarkers = v return s } // SetBaseUrlContent sets the BaseUrlContent field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetBaseUrlContent(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.BaseUrlContent = &v return s } // SetBaseUrlManifest sets the BaseUrlManifest field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetBaseUrlManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.BaseUrlManifest = &v return s } // SetCaptionLanguageMappings sets the CaptionLanguageMappings field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCaptionLanguageMappings(v []*CaptionLanguageMapping) *HlsGroupSettings { s.CaptionLanguageMappings = v return s } // SetCaptionLanguageSetting sets the CaptionLanguageSetting field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCaptionLanguageSetting(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.CaptionLanguageSetting = &v return s } // SetClientCache sets the ClientCache field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetClientCache(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ClientCache = &v return s } // SetCodecSpecification sets the CodecSpecification field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCodecSpecification(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.CodecSpecification = &v return s } // SetConstantIv sets the ConstantIv field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetConstantIv(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ConstantIv = &v return s } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *HlsGroupSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // SetDirectoryStructure sets the DirectoryStructure field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetDirectoryStructure(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.DirectoryStructure = &v return s } // SetEncryptionType sets the EncryptionType field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetEncryptionType(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.EncryptionType = &v return s } // SetHlsCdnSettings sets the HlsCdnSettings field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetHlsCdnSettings(v *HlsCdnSettings) *HlsGroupSettings { s.HlsCdnSettings = v return s } // SetIFrameOnlyPlaylists sets the IFrameOnlyPlaylists field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIFrameOnlyPlaylists(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.IFrameOnlyPlaylists = &v return s } // SetIndexNSegments sets the IndexNSegments field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIndexNSegments(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.IndexNSegments = &v return s } // SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.InputLossAction = &v return s } // SetIvInManifest sets the IvInManifest field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIvInManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.IvInManifest = &v return s } // SetIvSource sets the IvSource field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIvSource(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.IvSource = &v return s } // SetKeepSegments sets the KeepSegments field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeepSegments(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.KeepSegments = &v return s } // SetKeyFormat sets the KeyFormat field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyFormat(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.KeyFormat = &v return s } // SetKeyFormatVersions sets the KeyFormatVersions field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyFormatVersions(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.KeyFormatVersions = &v return s } // SetKeyProviderSettings sets the KeyProviderSettings field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyProviderSettings(v *KeyProviderSettings) *HlsGroupSettings { s.KeyProviderSettings = v return s } // SetManifestCompression sets the ManifestCompression field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetManifestCompression(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ManifestCompression = &v return s } // SetManifestDurationFormat sets the ManifestDurationFormat field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetManifestDurationFormat(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ManifestDurationFormat = &v return s } // SetMinSegmentLength sets the MinSegmentLength field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetMinSegmentLength(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.MinSegmentLength = &v return s } // SetMode sets the Mode field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.Mode = &v return s } // SetOutputSelection sets the OutputSelection field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetOutputSelection(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.OutputSelection = &v return s } // SetProgramDateTime sets the ProgramDateTime field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetProgramDateTime(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ProgramDateTime = &v return s } // SetProgramDateTimePeriod sets the ProgramDateTimePeriod field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetProgramDateTimePeriod(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.ProgramDateTimePeriod = &v return s } // SetRedundantManifest sets the RedundantManifest field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetRedundantManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.RedundantManifest = &v return s } // SetSegmentLength sets the SegmentLength field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentLength(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.SegmentLength = &v return s } // SetSegmentationMode sets the SegmentationMode field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentationMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.SegmentationMode = &v return s } // SetSegmentsPerSubdirectory sets the SegmentsPerSubdirectory field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentsPerSubdirectory(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory = &v return s } // SetStreamInfResolution sets the StreamInfResolution field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetStreamInfResolution(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.StreamInfResolution = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataId3Frame sets the TimedMetadataId3Frame field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Frame(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.TimedMetadataId3Frame = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataId3Period sets the TimedMetadataId3Period field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Period(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.TimedMetadataId3Period = &v return s } // SetTimestampDeltaMilliseconds sets the TimestampDeltaMilliseconds field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimestampDeltaMilliseconds(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings { s.TimestampDeltaMilliseconds = &v return s } // SetTsFileMode sets the TsFileMode field's value. func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTsFileMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings { s.TsFileMode = &v return s } type HlsInputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When specified the HLS stream with the m3u8 BANDWIDTH that most closely matches // this value will be chosen, otherwise the highest bandwidth stream in the // m3u8 will be chosen. The bitrate is specified in bits per second, as in an // HLS manifest. Bandwidth *int64 `locationName:"bandwidth" type:"integer"` // When specified, reading of the HLS input will begin this many buffer segments // from the end (most recently written segment). When not specified, the HLS // input will begin with the first segment specified in the m3u8. BufferSegments *int64 `locationName:"bufferSegments" type:"integer"` // The number of consecutive times that attempts to read a manifest or segment // must fail before the input is considered unavailable. Retries *int64 `locationName:"retries" type:"integer"` // The number of seconds between retries when an attempt to read a manifest // or segment fails. RetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"retryInterval" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsInputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsInputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetBandwidth sets the Bandwidth field's value. func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetBandwidth(v int64) *HlsInputSettings { s.Bandwidth = &v return s } // SetBufferSegments sets the BufferSegments field's value. func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetBufferSegments(v int64) *HlsInputSettings { s.BufferSegments = &v return s } // SetRetries sets the Retries field's value. func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetRetries(v int64) *HlsInputSettings { s.Retries = &v return s } // SetRetryInterval sets the RetryInterval field's value. func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsInputSettings { s.RetryInterval = &v return s } type HlsMediaStoreSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection // is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"` // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"` // When set to temporal, output files are stored in non-persistent memory for // faster reading and writing. MediaStoreStorageClass *string `locationName:"mediaStoreStorageClass" type:"string" enum:"HlsMediaStoreStorageClass"` // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into // an error state. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsMediaStoreSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsMediaStoreSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value. func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings { s.FilecacheDuration = &v return s } // SetMediaStoreStorageClass sets the MediaStoreStorageClass field's value. func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetMediaStoreStorageClass(v string) *HlsMediaStoreSettings { s.MediaStoreStorageClass = &v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } type HlsOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Settings regarding the underlying stream. These settings are different for // audio-only outputs. // // HlsSettings is a required field HlsSettings *HlsSettings `locationName:"hlsSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Accepts \"Format // Identifiers\":#formatIdentifierParameters. NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" min:"1" type:"string"` // String concatenated to end of segment filenames. SegmentModifier *string `locationName:"segmentModifier" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *HlsOutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsOutputSettings"} if s.HlsSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HlsSettings")) } if s.NameModifier != nil && len(*s.NameModifier) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NameModifier", 1)) } if s.HlsSettings != nil { if err := s.HlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("HlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetHlsSettings sets the HlsSettings field's value. func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetHlsSettings(v *HlsSettings) *HlsOutputSettings { s.HlsSettings = v return s } // SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value. func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *HlsOutputSettings { s.NameModifier = &v return s } // SetSegmentModifier sets the SegmentModifier field's value. func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetSegmentModifier(v string) *HlsOutputSettings { s.SegmentModifier = &v return s } type HlsSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AudioOnlyHlsSettings *AudioOnlyHlsSettings `locationName:"audioOnlyHlsSettings" type:"structure"` StandardHlsSettings *StandardHlsSettings `locationName:"standardHlsSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *HlsSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsSettings"} if s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings != nil { if err := s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("AudioOnlyHlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.StandardHlsSettings != nil { if err := s.StandardHlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("StandardHlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioOnlyHlsSettings sets the AudioOnlyHlsSettings field's value. func (s *HlsSettings) SetAudioOnlyHlsSettings(v *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) *HlsSettings { s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings = v return s } // SetStandardHlsSettings sets the StandardHlsSettings field's value. func (s *HlsSettings) SetStandardHlsSettings(v *StandardHlsSettings) *HlsSettings { s.StandardHlsSettings = v return s } // Settings for the action to emit HLS metadata type HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Base64 string formatted according to the ID3 specification: http://id3.org/id3v2.4.0-structure // // Id3 is a required field Id3 *string `locationName:"id3" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings"} if s.Id3 == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id3")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetId3 sets the Id3 field's value. func (s *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) SetId3(v string) *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings { s.Id3 = &v return s } type HlsWebdavSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection // is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"` // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"` // Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to WebDAV. HttpTransferMode *string `locationName:"httpTransferMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode"` // Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into // an error state. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HlsWebdavSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HlsWebdavSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value. func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings { s.FilecacheDuration = &v return s } // SetHttpTransferMode sets the HttpTransferMode field's value. func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetHttpTransferMode(v string) *HlsWebdavSettings { s.HttpTransferMode = &v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } type Input struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Unique ARN of the input (generated, immutable). Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // A list of channel IDs that that input is attached to (currently an input // can only be attached to one channel). AttachedChannels []*string `locationName:"attachedChannels" type:"list"` // A list of the destinations of the input (PUSH-type). Destinations []*InputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` // The generated ID of the input (unique for user account, immutable). Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` // A list of MediaConnect Flows for this input. MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlow `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"` // The user-assigned name (This is a mutable value). Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role this input assumes during and // after creation. RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` // A list of IDs for all the security groups attached to the input. SecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"securityGroups" type:"list"` // A list of the sources of the input (PULL-type). Sources []*InputSource `locationName:"sources" type:"list"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputState"` Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Input) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Input) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Input) SetArn(v string) *Input { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetAttachedChannels sets the AttachedChannels field's value. func (s *Input) SetAttachedChannels(v []*string) *Input { s.AttachedChannels = v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *Input) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestination) *Input { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *Input) SetId(v string) *Input { s.Id = &v return s } // SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value. func (s *Input) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlow) *Input { s.MediaConnectFlows = v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *Input) SetName(v string) *Input { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *Input) SetRoleArn(v string) *Input { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetSecurityGroups sets the SecurityGroups field's value. func (s *Input) SetSecurityGroups(v []*string) *Input { s.SecurityGroups = v return s } // SetSources sets the Sources field's value. func (s *Input) SetSources(v []*InputSource) *Input { s.Sources = v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *Input) SetState(v string) *Input { s.State = &v return s } // SetType sets the Type field's value. func (s *Input) SetType(v string) *Input { s.Type = &v return s } type InputAttachment struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // User-specified name for the attachment. This is required if the user wants // to use this input in an input switch action. InputAttachmentName *string `locationName:"inputAttachmentName" type:"string"` // The ID of the input InputId *string `locationName:"inputId" type:"string"` // Settings of an input (caption selector, etc.) InputSettings *InputSettings `locationName:"inputSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputAttachment) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputAttachment) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputAttachment) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputAttachment"} if s.InputSettings != nil { if err := s.InputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("InputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputAttachmentName sets the InputAttachmentName field's value. func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputAttachmentName(v string) *InputAttachment { s.InputAttachmentName = &v return s } // SetInputId sets the InputId field's value. func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputId(v string) *InputAttachment { s.InputId = &v return s } // SetInputSettings sets the InputSettings field's value. func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputSettings(v *InputSettings) *InputAttachment { s.InputSettings = v return s } type InputChannelLevel struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Remixing value. Units are in dB and acceptable values are within the range // from -60 (mute) and 6 dB. // // Gain is a required field Gain *int64 `locationName:"gain" type:"integer" required:"true"` // The index of the input channel used as a source. // // InputChannel is a required field InputChannel *int64 `locationName:"inputChannel" type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputChannelLevel) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputChannelLevel) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputChannelLevel) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputChannelLevel"} if s.Gain == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Gain")) } if s.Gain != nil && *s.Gain < -60 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Gain", -60)) } if s.InputChannel == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputChannel")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetGain sets the Gain field's value. func (s *InputChannelLevel) SetGain(v int64) *InputChannelLevel { s.Gain = &v return s } // SetInputChannel sets the InputChannel field's value. func (s *InputChannelLevel) SetInputChannel(v int64) *InputChannelLevel { s.InputChannel = &v return s } // The settings for a PUSH type input. type InputDestination struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The system-generated static IP address of endpoint.It remains fixed for the // lifetime of the input. Ip *string `locationName:"ip" type:"string"` // The port number for the input. Port *string `locationName:"port" type:"string"` // This represents the endpoint that the customer stream will bepushed to. Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputDestination) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputDestination) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetIp sets the Ip field's value. func (s *InputDestination) SetIp(v string) *InputDestination { s.Ip = &v return s } // SetPort sets the Port field's value. func (s *InputDestination) SetPort(v string) *InputDestination { s.Port = &v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *InputDestination) SetUrl(v string) *InputDestination { s.Url = &v return s } // Endpoint settings for a PUSH type input. type InputDestinationRequest struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique name for the location the RTMP stream is being pushedto. StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputDestinationRequest) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputDestinationRequest) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value. func (s *InputDestinationRequest) SetStreamName(v string) *InputDestinationRequest { s.StreamName = &v return s } type InputLocation struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"` // Uniform Resource Identifier - This should be a path to a file accessible // to the Live system (eg. a http:// URI) depending on the output type. For // example, a RTMP destination should have a uri simliar to: "rtmp://fmsserver/live". // // Uri is a required field Uri *string `locationName:"uri" type:"string" required:"true"` // Username if credentials are required to access a file or publishing point. // This can be either a plaintext username, or a reference to an AWS parameter // store name from which the username can be retrieved. AWS Parameter store // format: "ssm://" Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputLocation) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputLocation) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputLocation) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputLocation"} if s.Uri == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Uri")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value. func (s *InputLocation) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputLocation { s.PasswordParam = &v return s } // SetUri sets the Uri field's value. func (s *InputLocation) SetUri(v string) *InputLocation { s.Uri = &v return s } // SetUsername sets the Username field's value. func (s *InputLocation) SetUsername(v string) *InputLocation { s.Username = &v return s } type InputLossBehavior struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // On input loss, the number of milliseconds to substitute black into the output // before switching to the frame specified by inputLossImageType. A value x, // where 0 <= x <= 1,000,000 and a value of 1,000,000 will be interpreted as // infinite. BlackFrameMsec *int64 `locationName:"blackFrameMsec" type:"integer"` // When input loss image type is "color" this field specifies the color to use. // Value: 6 hex characters representing the values of RGB. InputLossImageColor *string `locationName:"inputLossImageColor" min:"6" type:"string"` // When input loss image type is "slate" these fields specify the parameters // for accessing the slate. InputLossImageSlate *InputLocation `locationName:"inputLossImageSlate" type:"structure"` // Indicates whether to substitute a solid color or a slate into the output // after input loss exceeds blackFrameMsec. InputLossImageType *string `locationName:"inputLossImageType" type:"string" enum:"InputLossImageType"` // On input loss, the number of milliseconds to repeat the previous picture // before substituting black into the output. A value x, where 0 <= x <= 1,000,000 // and a value of 1,000,000 will be interpreted as infinite. RepeatFrameMsec *int64 `locationName:"repeatFrameMsec" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputLossBehavior) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputLossBehavior) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputLossBehavior) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputLossBehavior"} if s.InputLossImageColor != nil && len(*s.InputLossImageColor) < 6 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputLossImageColor", 6)) } if s.InputLossImageSlate != nil { if err := s.InputLossImageSlate.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("InputLossImageSlate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetBlackFrameMsec sets the BlackFrameMsec field's value. func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetBlackFrameMsec(v int64) *InputLossBehavior { s.BlackFrameMsec = &v return s } // SetInputLossImageColor sets the InputLossImageColor field's value. func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageColor(v string) *InputLossBehavior { s.InputLossImageColor = &v return s } // SetInputLossImageSlate sets the InputLossImageSlate field's value. func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageSlate(v *InputLocation) *InputLossBehavior { s.InputLossImageSlate = v return s } // SetInputLossImageType sets the InputLossImageType field's value. func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageType(v string) *InputLossBehavior { s.InputLossImageType = &v return s } // SetRepeatFrameMsec sets the RepeatFrameMsec field's value. func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetRepeatFrameMsec(v int64) *InputLossBehavior { s.RepeatFrameMsec = &v return s } // An Input Security Group type InputSecurityGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Unique ARN of Input Security Group Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // The Id of the Input Security Group Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` // The list of inputs currently using this Input Security Group. Inputs []*string `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"` // The current state of the Input Security Group. State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputSecurityGroupState"` // Whitelist rules and their sync status WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRule `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSecurityGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSecurityGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetArn(v string) *InputSecurityGroup { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetId(v string) *InputSecurityGroup { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value. func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetInputs(v []*string) *InputSecurityGroup { s.Inputs = v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetState(v string) *InputSecurityGroup { s.State = &v return s } // SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value. func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRule) *InputSecurityGroup { s.WhitelistRules = v return s } // Live Event input parameters. There can be multiple inputs in a single Live // Event. type InputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Used to select the audio stream to decode for inputs that have multiple available. AudioSelectors []*AudioSelector `locationName:"audioSelectors" type:"list"` // Used to select the caption input to use for inputs that have multiple available. CaptionSelectors []*CaptionSelector `locationName:"captionSelectors" type:"list"` // Enable or disable the deblock filter when filtering. DeblockFilter *string `locationName:"deblockFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputDeblockFilter"` // Enable or disable the denoise filter when filtering. DenoiseFilter *string `locationName:"denoiseFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputDenoiseFilter"` // Adjusts the magnitude of filtering from 1 (minimal) to 5 (strongest). FilterStrength *int64 `locationName:"filterStrength" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Turns on the filter for this input. MPEG-2 inputs have the deblocking filter // enabled by default.1) auto - filtering will be applied depending on input // type/quality2) disabled - no filtering will be applied to the input3) forced // - filtering will be applied regardless of input type InputFilter *string `locationName:"inputFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputFilter"` // Input settings. NetworkInputSettings *NetworkInputSettings `locationName:"networkInputSettings" type:"structure"` // Loop input if it is a file. This allows a file input to be streamed indefinitely. SourceEndBehavior *string `locationName:"sourceEndBehavior" type:"string" enum:"InputSourceEndBehavior"` // Informs which video elementary stream to decode for input types that have // multiple available. VideoSelector *VideoSelector `locationName:"videoSelector" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputSettings"} if s.FilterStrength != nil && *s.FilterStrength < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FilterStrength", 1)) } if s.AudioSelectors != nil { for i, v := range s.AudioSelectors { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "AudioSelectors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if s.CaptionSelectors != nil { for i, v := range s.CaptionSelectors { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionSelectors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioSelectors sets the AudioSelectors field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetAudioSelectors(v []*AudioSelector) *InputSettings { s.AudioSelectors = v return s } // SetCaptionSelectors sets the CaptionSelectors field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetCaptionSelectors(v []*CaptionSelector) *InputSettings { s.CaptionSelectors = v return s } // SetDeblockFilter sets the DeblockFilter field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetDeblockFilter(v string) *InputSettings { s.DeblockFilter = &v return s } // SetDenoiseFilter sets the DenoiseFilter field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetDenoiseFilter(v string) *InputSettings { s.DenoiseFilter = &v return s } // SetFilterStrength sets the FilterStrength field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetFilterStrength(v int64) *InputSettings { s.FilterStrength = &v return s } // SetInputFilter sets the InputFilter field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetInputFilter(v string) *InputSettings { s.InputFilter = &v return s } // SetNetworkInputSettings sets the NetworkInputSettings field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetNetworkInputSettings(v *NetworkInputSettings) *InputSettings { s.NetworkInputSettings = v return s } // SetSourceEndBehavior sets the SourceEndBehavior field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetSourceEndBehavior(v string) *InputSettings { s.SourceEndBehavior = &v return s } // SetVideoSelector sets the VideoSelector field's value. func (s *InputSettings) SetVideoSelector(v *VideoSelector) *InputSettings { s.VideoSelector = v return s } // The settings for a PULL type input. type InputSource struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store. PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"` // This represents the customer's source URL where stream ispulled from. Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"` // The username for the input source. Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSource) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSource) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value. func (s *InputSource) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputSource { s.PasswordParam = &v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *InputSource) SetUrl(v string) *InputSource { s.Url = &v return s } // SetUsername sets the Username field's value. func (s *InputSource) SetUsername(v string) *InputSource { s.Username = &v return s } // Settings for for a PULL type input. type InputSourceRequest struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store. PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"` // This represents the customer's source URL where stream ispulled from. Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"` // The username for the input source. Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSourceRequest) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSourceRequest) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value. func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputSourceRequest { s.PasswordParam = &v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetUrl(v string) *InputSourceRequest { s.Url = &v return s } // SetUsername sets the Username field's value. func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetUsername(v string) *InputSourceRequest { s.Username = &v return s } type InputSpecification struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Input codec Codec *string `locationName:"codec" type:"string" enum:"InputCodec"` // Maximum input bitrate, categorized coarsely MaximumBitrate *string `locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string" enum:"InputMaximumBitrate"` // Input resolution, categorized coarsely Resolution *string `locationName:"resolution" type:"string" enum:"InputResolution"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSpecification) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSpecification) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCodec sets the Codec field's value. func (s *InputSpecification) SetCodec(v string) *InputSpecification { s.Codec = &v return s } // SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value. func (s *InputSpecification) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *InputSpecification { s.MaximumBitrate = &v return s } // SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value. func (s *InputSpecification) SetResolution(v string) *InputSpecification { s.Resolution = &v return s } // Settings for the action to switch an input. type InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the input attachment that should be switched to by this action. // // InputAttachmentNameReference is a required field InputAttachmentNameReference *string `locationName:"inputAttachmentNameReference" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings"} if s.InputAttachmentNameReference == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputAttachmentNameReference")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputAttachmentNameReference sets the InputAttachmentNameReference field's value. func (s *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) SetInputAttachmentNameReference(v string) *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings { s.InputAttachmentNameReference = &v return s } // Whitelist rule type InputWhitelistRule struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The IPv4 CIDR that's whitelisted. Cidr *string `locationName:"cidr" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputWhitelistRule) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputWhitelistRule) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCidr sets the Cidr field's value. func (s *InputWhitelistRule) SetCidr(v string) *InputWhitelistRule { s.Cidr = &v return s } // An IPv4 CIDR to whitelist. type InputWhitelistRuleCidr struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The IPv4 CIDR to whitelist. Cidr *string `locationName:"cidr" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s InputWhitelistRuleCidr) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s InputWhitelistRuleCidr) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCidr sets the Cidr field's value. func (s *InputWhitelistRuleCidr) SetCidr(v string) *InputWhitelistRuleCidr { s.Cidr = &v return s } type KeyProviderSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` StaticKeySettings *StaticKeySettings `locationName:"staticKeySettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s KeyProviderSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s KeyProviderSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *KeyProviderSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "KeyProviderSettings"} if s.StaticKeySettings != nil { if err := s.StaticKeySettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("StaticKeySettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetStaticKeySettings sets the StaticKeySettings field's value. func (s *KeyProviderSettings) SetStaticKeySettings(v *StaticKeySettings) *KeyProviderSettings { s.StaticKeySettings = v return s } type ListChannelsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListChannelsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListChannelsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListChannelsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListChannelsInput"} if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *ListChannelsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListChannelsInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListChannelsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListChannelsInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListChannelsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Channels []*ChannelSummary `locationName:"channels" type:"list"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListChannelsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListChannelsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetChannels sets the Channels field's value. func (s *ListChannelsOutput) SetChannels(v []*ChannelSummary) *ListChannelsOutput { s.Channels = v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListChannelsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListChannelsOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListInputSecurityGroupsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInputSecurityGroupsInput"} if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` InputSecurityGroups []*InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*InputSecurityGroup) *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput { s.InputSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListInputsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInputsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInputsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListInputsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInputsInput"} if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *ListInputsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListInputsInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListInputsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputsInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListInputsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Inputs []*Input `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListInputsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListInputsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value. func (s *ListInputsOutput) SetInputs(v []*Input) *ListInputsOutput { s.Inputs = v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListInputsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputsOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } type ListOfferingsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` ChannelConfiguration *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"channelConfiguration" type:"string"` Codec *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"codec" type:"string"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` MaximumBitrate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string"` MaximumFramerate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` Resolution *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resolution" type:"string"` ResourceType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resourceType" type:"string"` SpecialFeature *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string"` VideoQuality *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListOfferingsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListOfferingsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListOfferingsInput"} if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelConfiguration sets the ChannelConfiguration field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetChannelConfiguration(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.ChannelConfiguration = &v return s } // SetCodec sets the Codec field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetCodec(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.Codec = &v return s } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListOfferingsInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.MaximumBitrate = &v return s } // SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.MaximumFramerate = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } // SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetResolution(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.Resolution = &v return s } // SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetResourceType(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.ResourceType = &v return s } // SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.SpecialFeature = &v return s } // SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ListOfferingsInput { s.VideoQuality = &v return s } type ListOfferingsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` Offerings []*Offering `locationName:"offerings" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListOfferingsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListOfferingsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListOfferingsOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } // SetOfferings sets the Offerings field's value. func (s *ListOfferingsOutput) SetOfferings(v []*Offering) *ListOfferingsOutput { s.Offerings = v return s } type ListReservationsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Codec *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"codec" type:"string"` MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"` MaximumBitrate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string"` MaximumFramerate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string"` NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` Resolution *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resolution" type:"string"` ResourceType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resourceType" type:"string"` SpecialFeature *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string"` VideoQuality *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListReservationsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListReservationsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ListReservationsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListReservationsInput"} if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCodec sets the Codec field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetCodec(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.Codec = &v return s } // SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListReservationsInput { s.MaxResults = &v return s } // SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.MaximumBitrate = &v return s } // SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.MaximumFramerate = &v return s } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.NextToken = &v return s } // SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetResolution(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.Resolution = &v return s } // SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetResourceType(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.ResourceType = &v return s } // SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.SpecialFeature = &v return s } // SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value. func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ListReservationsInput { s.VideoQuality = &v return s } type ListReservationsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"` Reservations []*Reservation `locationName:"reservations" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ListReservationsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ListReservationsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value. func (s *ListReservationsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListReservationsOutput { s.NextToken = &v return s } // SetReservations sets the Reservations field's value. func (s *ListReservationsOutput) SetReservations(v []*Reservation) *ListReservationsOutput { s.Reservations = v return s } type M2tsSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When set to drop, output audio streams will be removed from the program if // the selected input audio stream is removed from the input. This allows the // output audio configuration to dynamically change based on input configuration. // If this is set to encodeSilence, all output audio streams will output encoded // silence when not connected to an active input stream. AbsentInputAudioBehavior *string `locationName:"absentInputAudioBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior"` // When set to enabled, uses ARIB-compliant field muxing and removes video descriptor. Arib *string `locationName:"arib" type:"string" enum:"M2tsArib"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for ARIB Captions in the transport stream. Can be // entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 // (or 0x1ff6). AribCaptionsPid *string `locationName:"aribCaptionsPid" type:"string"` // If set to auto, pid number used for ARIB Captions will be auto-selected from // unused pids. If set to useConfigured, ARIB Captions will be on the configured // pid number. AribCaptionsPidControl *string `locationName:"aribCaptionsPidControl" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl"` // When set to dvb, uses DVB buffer model for Dolby Digital audio. When set // to atsc, the ATSC model is used. AudioBufferModel *string `locationName:"audioBufferModel" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioBufferModel"` // The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet. AudioFramesPerPes *int64 `locationName:"audioFramesPerPes" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport // stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or // by comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each // PID specified must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). AudioPids *string `locationName:"audioPids" type:"string"` // When set to atsc, uses stream type = 0x81 for AC3 and stream type = 0x87 // for EAC3. When set to dvb, uses stream type = 0x06. AudioStreamType *string `locationName:"audioStreamType" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioStreamType"` // The output bitrate of the transport stream in bits per second. Setting to // 0 lets the muxer automatically determine the appropriate bitrate. Bitrate *int64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"integer"` // If set to multiplex, use multiplex buffer model for accurate interleaving. // Setting to bufferModel to none can lead to lower latency, but low-memory // devices may not be able to play back the stream without interruptions. BufferModel *string `locationName:"bufferModel" type:"string" enum:"M2tsBufferModel"` // When set to enabled, generates captionServiceDescriptor in PMT. CcDescriptor *string `locationName:"ccDescriptor" type:"string" enum:"M2tsCcDescriptor"` // Inserts DVB Network Information Table (NIT) at the specified table repetition // interval. DvbNitSettings *DvbNitSettings `locationName:"dvbNitSettings" type:"structure"` // Inserts DVB Service Description Table (SDT) at the specified table repetition // interval. DvbSdtSettings *DvbSdtSettings `locationName:"dvbSdtSettings" type:"structure"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Subtitle data to this output. // Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma // separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified // must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). DvbSubPids *string `locationName:"dvbSubPids" type:"string"` // Inserts DVB Time and Date Table (TDT) at the specified table repetition interval. DvbTdtSettings *DvbTdtSettings `locationName:"dvbTdtSettings" type:"structure"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Teletext data to this output. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). DvbTeletextPid *string `locationName:"dvbTeletextPid" type:"string"` // If set to passthrough, passes any EBIF data from the input source to this // output. Ebif *string `locationName:"ebif" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEbifControl"` // When videoAndFixedIntervals is selected, audio EBP markers will be added // to partitions 3 and 4. The interval between these additional markers will // be fixed, and will be slightly shorter than the video EBP marker interval. // Only available when EBP Cablelabs segmentation markers are selected. Partitions // 1 and 2 will always follow the video interval. EbpAudioInterval *string `locationName:"ebpAudioInterval" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioInterval"` // When set, enforces that Encoder Boundary Points do not come within the specified // time interval of each other by looking ahead at input video. If another EBP // is going to come in within the specified time interval, the current EBP is // not emitted, and the segment is "stretched" to the next marker. The lookahead // value does not add latency to the system. The Live Event must be configured // elsewhere to create sufficient latency to make the lookahead accurate. EbpLookaheadMs *int64 `locationName:"ebpLookaheadMs" type:"integer"` // Controls placement of EBP on Audio PIDs. If set to videoAndAudioPids, EBP // markers will be placed on the video PID and all audio PIDs. If set to videoPid, // EBP markers will be placed on only the video PID. EbpPlacement *string `locationName:"ebpPlacement" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEbpPlacement"` // This field is unused and deprecated. EcmPid *string `locationName:"ecmPid" type:"string"` // Include or exclude the ES Rate field in the PES header. EsRateInPes *string `locationName:"esRateInPes" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEsRateInPes"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Platform data to this output. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). EtvPlatformPid *string `locationName:"etvPlatformPid" type:"string"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Signal data to this output. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). EtvSignalPid *string `locationName:"etvSignalPid" type:"string"` // The length in seconds of each fragment. Only used with EBP markers. FragmentTime *float64 `locationName:"fragmentTime" type:"double"` // If set to passthrough, passes any KLV data from the input source to this // output. Klv *string `locationName:"klv" type:"string" enum:"M2tsKlv"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source KLV data to this output. Multiple // values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation. // Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must // be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). KlvDataPids *string `locationName:"klvDataPids" type:"string"` // Value in bits per second of extra null packets to insert into the transport // stream. This can be used if a downstream encryption system requires periodic // null packets. NullPacketBitrate *float64 `locationName:"nullPacketBitrate" type:"double"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000. PatInterval *int64 `locationName:"patInterval" type:"integer"` // When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted // for every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective // only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream. PcrControl *string `locationName:"pcrControl" type:"string" enum:"M2tsPcrControl"` // Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock Reference (PCRs) inserted // into the transport stream. PcrPeriod *int64 `locationName:"pcrPeriod" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport // stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as // the Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values // are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). PcrPid *string `locationName:"pcrPid" type:"string"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000. PmtInterval *int64 `locationName:"pmtInterval" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport // stream. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are // 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). PmtPid *string `locationName:"pmtPid" type:"string"` // The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table. ProgramNum *int64 `locationName:"programNum" type:"integer"` // When vbr, does not insert null packets into transport stream to fill specified // bitrate. The bitrate setting acts as the maximum bitrate when vbr is set. RateMode *string `locationName:"rateMode" type:"string" enum:"M2tsRateMode"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for input source SCTE-27 data to this output. Multiple // values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation. // Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must // be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). Scte27Pids *string `locationName:"scte27Pids" type:"string"` // Optionally pass SCTE-35 signals from the input source to this output. Scte35Control *string `locationName:"scte35Control" type:"string" enum:"M2tsScte35Control"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can // be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 // (or 0x1ff6). Scte35Pid *string `locationName:"scte35Pid" type:"string"` // Inserts segmentation markers at each segmentationTime period. raiSegstart // sets the Random Access Indicator bit in the adaptation field. raiAdapt sets // the RAI bit and adds the current timecode in the private data bytes. psiSegstart // inserts PAT and PMT tables at the start of segments. ebp adds Encoder Boundary // Point information to the adaptation field as per OpenCable specification // OC-SP-EBP-I01-130118. ebpLegacy adds Encoder Boundary Point information to // the adaptation field using a legacy proprietary format. SegmentationMarkers *string `locationName:"segmentationMarkers" type:"string" enum:"M2tsSegmentationMarkers"` // The segmentation style parameter controls how segmentation markers are inserted // into the transport stream. With avails, it is possible that segments may // be truncated, which can influence where future segmentation markers are inserted.When // a segmentation style of "resetCadence" is selected and a segment is truncated // due to an avail, we will reset the segmentation cadence. This means the subsequent // segment will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds.When a segmentation // style of "maintainCadence" is selected and a segment is truncated due to // an avail, we will not reset the segmentation cadence. This means the subsequent // segment will likely be truncated as well. However, all segments after that // will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds. Note that EBP lookahead // is a slight exception to this rule. SegmentationStyle *string `locationName:"segmentationStyle" type:"string" enum:"M2tsSegmentationStyle"` // The length in seconds of each segment. Required unless markers is set to // None_. SegmentationTime *float64 `locationName:"segmentationTime" type:"double"` // When set to passthrough, timed metadata will be passed through from input // to output. TimedMetadataBehavior *string `locationName:"timedMetadataBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). TimedMetadataPid *string `locationName:"timedMetadataPid" type:"string"` // The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table. TransportStreamId *int64 `locationName:"transportStreamId" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). VideoPid *string `locationName:"videoPid" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s M2tsSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s M2tsSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *M2tsSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "M2tsSettings"} if s.DvbNitSettings != nil { if err := s.DvbNitSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DvbNitSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.DvbSdtSettings != nil { if err := s.DvbSdtSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSdtSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.DvbTdtSettings != nil { if err := s.DvbTdtSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DvbTdtSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAbsentInputAudioBehavior sets the AbsentInputAudioBehavior field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAbsentInputAudioBehavior(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AbsentInputAudioBehavior = &v return s } // SetArib sets the Arib field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetArib(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Arib = &v return s } // SetAribCaptionsPid sets the AribCaptionsPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAribCaptionsPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AribCaptionsPid = &v return s } // SetAribCaptionsPidControl sets the AribCaptionsPidControl field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAribCaptionsPidControl(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AribCaptionsPidControl = &v return s } // SetAudioBufferModel sets the AudioBufferModel field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioBufferModel(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AudioBufferModel = &v return s } // SetAudioFramesPerPes sets the AudioFramesPerPes field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioFramesPerPes(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.AudioFramesPerPes = &v return s } // SetAudioPids sets the AudioPids field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioPids(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AudioPids = &v return s } // SetAudioStreamType sets the AudioStreamType field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioStreamType(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.AudioStreamType = &v return s } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetBitrate(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetBufferModel sets the BufferModel field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetBufferModel(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.BufferModel = &v return s } // SetCcDescriptor sets the CcDescriptor field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetCcDescriptor(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.CcDescriptor = &v return s } // SetDvbNitSettings sets the DvbNitSettings field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbNitSettings(v *DvbNitSettings) *M2tsSettings { s.DvbNitSettings = v return s } // SetDvbSdtSettings sets the DvbSdtSettings field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbSdtSettings(v *DvbSdtSettings) *M2tsSettings { s.DvbSdtSettings = v return s } // SetDvbSubPids sets the DvbSubPids field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbSubPids(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.DvbSubPids = &v return s } // SetDvbTdtSettings sets the DvbTdtSettings field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbTdtSettings(v *DvbTdtSettings) *M2tsSettings { s.DvbTdtSettings = v return s } // SetDvbTeletextPid sets the DvbTeletextPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbTeletextPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.DvbTeletextPid = &v return s } // SetEbif sets the Ebif field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbif(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Ebif = &v return s } // SetEbpAudioInterval sets the EbpAudioInterval field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpAudioInterval(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EbpAudioInterval = &v return s } // SetEbpLookaheadMs sets the EbpLookaheadMs field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpLookaheadMs(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.EbpLookaheadMs = &v return s } // SetEbpPlacement sets the EbpPlacement field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpPlacement(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EbpPlacement = &v return s } // SetEcmPid sets the EcmPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEcmPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EcmPid = &v return s } // SetEsRateInPes sets the EsRateInPes field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEsRateInPes(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EsRateInPes = &v return s } // SetEtvPlatformPid sets the EtvPlatformPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEtvPlatformPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EtvPlatformPid = &v return s } // SetEtvSignalPid sets the EtvSignalPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEtvSignalPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.EtvSignalPid = &v return s } // SetFragmentTime sets the FragmentTime field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetFragmentTime(v float64) *M2tsSettings { s.FragmentTime = &v return s } // SetKlv sets the Klv field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetKlv(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Klv = &v return s } // SetKlvDataPids sets the KlvDataPids field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetKlvDataPids(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.KlvDataPids = &v return s } // SetNullPacketBitrate sets the NullPacketBitrate field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetNullPacketBitrate(v float64) *M2tsSettings { s.NullPacketBitrate = &v return s } // SetPatInterval sets the PatInterval field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPatInterval(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.PatInterval = &v return s } // SetPcrControl sets the PcrControl field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrControl(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.PcrControl = &v return s } // SetPcrPeriod sets the PcrPeriod field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrPeriod(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.PcrPeriod = &v return s } // SetPcrPid sets the PcrPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.PcrPid = &v return s } // SetPmtInterval sets the PmtInterval field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPmtInterval(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.PmtInterval = &v return s } // SetPmtPid sets the PmtPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPmtPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.PmtPid = &v return s } // SetProgramNum sets the ProgramNum field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetProgramNum(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.ProgramNum = &v return s } // SetRateMode sets the RateMode field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetRateMode(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.RateMode = &v return s } // SetScte27Pids sets the Scte27Pids field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte27Pids(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Scte27Pids = &v return s } // SetScte35Control sets the Scte35Control field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte35Control(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Scte35Control = &v return s } // SetScte35Pid sets the Scte35Pid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte35Pid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.Scte35Pid = &v return s } // SetSegmentationMarkers sets the SegmentationMarkers field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationMarkers(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.SegmentationMarkers = &v return s } // SetSegmentationStyle sets the SegmentationStyle field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationStyle(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.SegmentationStyle = &v return s } // SetSegmentationTime sets the SegmentationTime field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationTime(v float64) *M2tsSettings { s.SegmentationTime = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataBehavior sets the TimedMetadataBehavior field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTimedMetadataBehavior(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.TimedMetadataBehavior = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataPid sets the TimedMetadataPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTimedMetadataPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.TimedMetadataPid = &v return s } // SetTransportStreamId sets the TransportStreamId field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTransportStreamId(v int64) *M2tsSettings { s.TransportStreamId = &v return s } // SetVideoPid sets the VideoPid field's value. func (s *M2tsSettings) SetVideoPid(v string) *M2tsSettings { s.VideoPid = &v return s } // Settings information for the .m3u8 container type M3u8Settings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet. AudioFramesPerPes *int64 `locationName:"audioFramesPerPes" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport // stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or // by comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. AudioPids *string `locationName:"audioPids" type:"string"` // This parameter is unused and deprecated. EcmPid *string `locationName:"ecmPid" type:"string"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. A value of \"0\" writes out the PMT once per segment file. PatInterval *int64 `locationName:"patInterval" type:"integer"` // When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted // for every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective // only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream. PcrControl *string `locationName:"pcrControl" type:"string" enum:"M3u8PcrControl"` // Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock References (PCRs) inserted // into the transport stream. PcrPeriod *int64 `locationName:"pcrPeriod" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport // stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as // the Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. PcrPid *string `locationName:"pcrPid" type:"string"` // The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output // transport stream. A value of \"0\" writes out the PMT once per segment file. PmtInterval *int64 `locationName:"pmtInterval" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport // stream. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. PmtPid *string `locationName:"pmtPid" type:"string"` // The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table. ProgramNum *int64 `locationName:"programNum" type:"integer"` // If set to passthrough, passes any SCTE-35 signals from the input source to // this output. Scte35Behavior *string `locationName:"scte35Behavior" type:"string" enum:"M3u8Scte35Behavior"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can // be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Scte35Pid *string `locationName:"scte35Pid" type:"string"` // When set to passthrough, timed metadata is passed through from input to output. TimedMetadataBehavior *string `locationName:"timedMetadataBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or // 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6). TimedMetadataPid *string `locationName:"timedMetadataPid" type:"string"` // The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table. TransportStreamId *int64 `locationName:"transportStreamId" type:"integer"` // Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream. // Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. VideoPid *string `locationName:"videoPid" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s M3u8Settings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s M3u8Settings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAudioFramesPerPes sets the AudioFramesPerPes field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetAudioFramesPerPes(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.AudioFramesPerPes = &v return s } // SetAudioPids sets the AudioPids field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetAudioPids(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.AudioPids = &v return s } // SetEcmPid sets the EcmPid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetEcmPid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.EcmPid = &v return s } // SetPatInterval sets the PatInterval field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPatInterval(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.PatInterval = &v return s } // SetPcrControl sets the PcrControl field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrControl(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.PcrControl = &v return s } // SetPcrPeriod sets the PcrPeriod field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrPeriod(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.PcrPeriod = &v return s } // SetPcrPid sets the PcrPid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrPid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.PcrPid = &v return s } // SetPmtInterval sets the PmtInterval field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPmtInterval(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.PmtInterval = &v return s } // SetPmtPid sets the PmtPid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPmtPid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.PmtPid = &v return s } // SetProgramNum sets the ProgramNum field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetProgramNum(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.ProgramNum = &v return s } // SetScte35Behavior sets the Scte35Behavior field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetScte35Behavior(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.Scte35Behavior = &v return s } // SetScte35Pid sets the Scte35Pid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetScte35Pid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.Scte35Pid = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataBehavior sets the TimedMetadataBehavior field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTimedMetadataBehavior(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.TimedMetadataBehavior = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataPid sets the TimedMetadataPid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTimedMetadataPid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.TimedMetadataPid = &v return s } // SetTransportStreamId sets the TransportStreamId field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTransportStreamId(v int64) *M3u8Settings { s.TransportStreamId = &v return s } // SetVideoPid sets the VideoPid field's value. func (s *M3u8Settings) SetVideoPid(v string) *M3u8Settings { s.VideoPid = &v return s } // The settings for a MediaConnect Flow. type MediaConnectFlow struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique ARN of the MediaConnect Flow being used as a source. FlowArn *string `locationName:"flowArn" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MediaConnectFlow) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MediaConnectFlow) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetFlowArn sets the FlowArn field's value. func (s *MediaConnectFlow) SetFlowArn(v string) *MediaConnectFlow { s.FlowArn = &v return s } // The settings for a MediaConnect Flow. type MediaConnectFlowRequest struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The ARN of the MediaConnect Flow that you want to use as a source. FlowArn *string `locationName:"flowArn" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MediaConnectFlowRequest) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MediaConnectFlowRequest) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetFlowArn sets the FlowArn field's value. func (s *MediaConnectFlowRequest) SetFlowArn(v string) *MediaConnectFlowRequest { s.FlowArn = &v return s } type Mp2Settings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Average bitrate in bits/second. Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"` // The MPEG2 Audio coding mode. Valid values are codingMode10 (for mono) or // codingMode20 (for stereo). CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Mp2CodingMode"` // Sample rate in Hz. SampleRate *float64 `locationName:"sampleRate" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Mp2Settings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Mp2Settings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value. func (s *Mp2Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Mp2Settings { s.Bitrate = &v return s } // SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value. func (s *Mp2Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Mp2Settings { s.CodingMode = &v return s } // SetSampleRate sets the SampleRate field's value. func (s *Mp2Settings) SetSampleRate(v float64) *Mp2Settings { s.SampleRate = &v return s } type MsSmoothGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The value of the "Acquisition Point Identity" element used in each message // placed in the sparse track. Only enabled if sparseTrackType is not "none". AcquisitionPointId *string `locationName:"acquisitionPointId" type:"string"` // If set to passthrough for an audio-only MS Smooth output, the fragment absolute // time will be set to the current timecode. This option does not write timecodes // to the audio elementary stream. AudioOnlyTimecodeControl *string `locationName:"audioOnlyTimecodeControl" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl"` // If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the https certificate chain to a trusted // Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause https outputs to self-signed // certificates to fail. CertificateMode *string `locationName:"certificateMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupCertificateMode"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the IIS server if // the connection is lost. Content will be cached during this time and the cache // will be be delivered to the IIS server once the connection is re-established. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"` // Smooth Streaming publish point on an IIS server. Elemental Live acts as a // "Push" encoder to IIS. // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` // MS Smooth event ID to be sent to the IIS server.Should only be specified // if eventIdMode is set to useConfigured. EventId *string `locationName:"eventId" type:"string"` // Specifies whether or not to send an event ID to the IIS server. If no event // ID is sent and the same Live Event is used without changing the publishing // point, clients might see cached video from the previous run.Options:- "useConfigured" // - use the value provided in eventId- "useTimestamp" - generate and send an // event ID based on the current timestamp- "noEventId" - do not send an event // ID to the IIS server. EventIdMode *string `locationName:"eventIdMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupEventIdMode"` // When set to sendEos, send EOS signal to IIS server when stopping the event EventStopBehavior *string `locationName:"eventStopBehavior" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior"` // Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs. FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"` // Length of mp4 fragments to generate (in seconds). Fragment length must be // compatible with GOP size and framerate. FragmentLength *int64 `locationName:"fragmentLength" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss. InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut"` // Number of retry attempts. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` // Number of seconds before initiating a restart due to output failure, due // to exhausting the numRetries on one segment, or exceeding filecacheDuration. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` // useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is // always used. SegmentationMode *string `locationName:"segmentationMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupSegmentationMode"` // Number of milliseconds to delay the output from the second pipeline. SendDelayMs *int64 `locationName:"sendDelayMs" type:"integer"` // If set to scte35, use incoming SCTE-35 messages to generate a sparse track // in this group of MS-Smooth outputs. SparseTrackType *string `locationName:"sparseTrackType" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupSparseTrackType"` // When set to send, send stream manifest so publishing point doesn't start // until all streams start. StreamManifestBehavior *string `locationName:"streamManifestBehavior" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior"` // Timestamp offset for the event. Only used if timestampOffsetMode is set to // useConfiguredOffset. TimestampOffset *string `locationName:"timestampOffset" type:"string"` // Type of timestamp date offset to use.- useEventStartDate: Use the date the // event was started as the offset- useConfiguredOffset: Use an explicitly configured // date as the offset TimestampOffsetMode *string `locationName:"timestampOffsetMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MsSmoothGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MsSmoothGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "MsSmoothGroupSettings"} if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if s.FragmentLength != nil && *s.FragmentLength < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FragmentLength", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAcquisitionPointId sets the AcquisitionPointId field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetAcquisitionPointId(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.AcquisitionPointId = &v return s } // SetAudioOnlyTimecodeControl sets the AudioOnlyTimecodeControl field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetAudioOnlyTimecodeControl(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.AudioOnlyTimecodeControl = &v return s } // SetCertificateMode sets the CertificateMode field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetCertificateMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.CertificateMode = &v return s } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // SetEventId sets the EventId field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventId(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.EventId = &v return s } // SetEventIdMode sets the EventIdMode field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventIdMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.EventIdMode = &v return s } // SetEventStopBehavior sets the EventStopBehavior field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventStopBehavior(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.EventStopBehavior = &v return s } // SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.FilecacheDuration = &v return s } // SetFragmentLength sets the FragmentLength field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetFragmentLength(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.FragmentLength = &v return s } // SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.InputLossAction = &v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } // SetSegmentationMode sets the SegmentationMode field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSegmentationMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.SegmentationMode = &v return s } // SetSendDelayMs sets the SendDelayMs field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSendDelayMs(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.SendDelayMs = &v return s } // SetSparseTrackType sets the SparseTrackType field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSparseTrackType(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.SparseTrackType = &v return s } // SetStreamManifestBehavior sets the StreamManifestBehavior field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetStreamManifestBehavior(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.StreamManifestBehavior = &v return s } // SetTimestampOffset sets the TimestampOffset field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetTimestampOffset(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.TimestampOffset = &v return s } // SetTimestampOffsetMode sets the TimestampOffsetMode field's value. func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetTimestampOffsetMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings { s.TimestampOffsetMode = &v return s } type MsSmoothOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for // multiple outputs of the same type. NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MsSmoothOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MsSmoothOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value. func (s *MsSmoothOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *MsSmoothOutputSettings { s.NameModifier = &v return s } // Network source to transcode. Must be accessible to the Elemental Live node // that is running the live event through a network connection. type NetworkInputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies HLS input settings when the uri is for a HLS manifest. HlsInputSettings *HlsInputSettings `locationName:"hlsInputSettings" type:"structure"` // Check HTTPS server certificates. When set to checkCryptographyOnly, cryptography // in the certificate will be checked, but not the server's name. Certain subdomains // (notably S3 buckets that use dots in the bucket name) do not strictly match // the corresponding certificate's wildcard pattern and would otherwise cause // the event to error. This setting is ignored for protocols that do not use // https. ServerValidation *string `locationName:"serverValidation" type:"string" enum:"NetworkInputServerValidation"` } // String returns the string representation func (s NetworkInputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s NetworkInputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHlsInputSettings sets the HlsInputSettings field's value. func (s *NetworkInputSettings) SetHlsInputSettings(v *HlsInputSettings) *NetworkInputSettings { s.HlsInputSettings = v return s } // SetServerValidation sets the ServerValidation field's value. func (s *NetworkInputSettings) SetServerValidation(v string) *NetworkInputSettings { s.ServerValidation = &v return s } // Reserved resources available for purchase type Offering struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Unique offering ARN, e.g. 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:offering:87654321' Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD' CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"` // Lease duration, e.g. '12' Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"` // One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"` // Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard // VQ in US West (Oregon)' OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"` // Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321' OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"` // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"` // AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2' Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"` // Resource configuration details ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"` // Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0' UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Offering) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Offering) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Offering) SetArn(v string) *Offering { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *Offering) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *Offering { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *Offering) SetDuration(v int64) *Offering { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value. func (s *Offering) SetDurationUnits(v string) *Offering { s.DurationUnits = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *Offering) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *Offering { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value. func (s *Offering) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *Offering { s.OfferingDescription = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *Offering) SetOfferingId(v string) *Offering { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *Offering) SetOfferingType(v string) *Offering { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *Offering) SetRegion(v string) *Offering { s.Region = &v return s } // SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value. func (s *Offering) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *Offering { s.ResourceSpecification = v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *Offering) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *Offering { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } // Output settings. There can be multiple outputs within a group. type Output struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The names of the AudioDescriptions used as audio sources for this output. AudioDescriptionNames []*string `locationName:"audioDescriptionNames" type:"list"` // The names of the CaptionDescriptions used as caption sources for this output. CaptionDescriptionNames []*string `locationName:"captionDescriptionNames" type:"list"` // The name used to identify an output. OutputName *string `locationName:"outputName" min:"1" type:"string"` // Output type-specific settings. // // OutputSettings is a required field OutputSettings *OutputSettings `locationName:"outputSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // The name of the VideoDescription used as the source for this output. VideoDescriptionName *string `locationName:"videoDescriptionName" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Output) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Output) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Output) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Output"} if s.OutputName != nil && len(*s.OutputName) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OutputName", 1)) } if s.OutputSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputSettings")) } if s.OutputSettings != nil { if err := s.OutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("OutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioDescriptionNames sets the AudioDescriptionNames field's value. func (s *Output) SetAudioDescriptionNames(v []*string) *Output { s.AudioDescriptionNames = v return s } // SetCaptionDescriptionNames sets the CaptionDescriptionNames field's value. func (s *Output) SetCaptionDescriptionNames(v []*string) *Output { s.CaptionDescriptionNames = v return s } // SetOutputName sets the OutputName field's value. func (s *Output) SetOutputName(v string) *Output { s.OutputName = &v return s } // SetOutputSettings sets the OutputSettings field's value. func (s *Output) SetOutputSettings(v *OutputSettings) *Output { s.OutputSettings = v return s } // SetVideoDescriptionName sets the VideoDescriptionName field's value. func (s *Output) SetVideoDescriptionName(v string) *Output { s.VideoDescriptionName = &v return s } type OutputDestination struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // User-specified id. This is used in an output group or an output. Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` // Destination settings for output; one for each redundant encoder. Settings []*OutputDestinationSettings `locationName:"settings" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputDestination) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputDestination) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *OutputDestination) SetId(v string) *OutputDestination { s.Id = &v return s } // SetSettings sets the Settings field's value. func (s *OutputDestination) SetSettings(v []*OutputDestinationSettings) *OutputDestination { s.Settings = v return s } type OutputDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"` // Stream name for RTMP destinations (URLs of type rtmp://) StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"` // A URL specifying a destination Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"` // username for destination Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value. func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetPasswordParam(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings { s.PasswordParam = &v return s } // SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value. func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetStreamName(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings { s.StreamName = &v return s } // SetUrl sets the Url field's value. func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetUrl(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings { s.Url = &v return s } // SetUsername sets the Username field's value. func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetUsername(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings { s.Username = &v return s } // Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about // where streams should be distributed. type OutputGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Custom output group name optionally defined by the user. Only letters, numbers, // and the underscore character allowed; only 32 characters allowed. Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // Settings associated with the output group. // // OutputGroupSettings is a required field OutputGroupSettings *OutputGroupSettings `locationName:"outputGroupSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Outputs is a required field Outputs []*Output `locationName:"outputs" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *OutputGroup) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputGroup"} if s.OutputGroupSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputGroupSettings")) } if s.Outputs == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Outputs")) } if s.OutputGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.OutputGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("OutputGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Outputs != nil { for i, v := range s.Outputs { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Outputs", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *OutputGroup) SetName(v string) *OutputGroup { s.Name = &v return s } // SetOutputGroupSettings sets the OutputGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroup) SetOutputGroupSettings(v *OutputGroupSettings) *OutputGroup { s.OutputGroupSettings = v return s } // SetOutputs sets the Outputs field's value. func (s *OutputGroup) SetOutputs(v []*Output) *OutputGroup { s.Outputs = v return s } type OutputGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` ArchiveGroupSettings *ArchiveGroupSettings `locationName:"archiveGroupSettings" type:"structure"` // Frame Capture Group Settings FrameCaptureGroupSettings *FrameCaptureGroupSettings `locationName:"frameCaptureGroupSettings" type:"structure"` HlsGroupSettings *HlsGroupSettings `locationName:"hlsGroupSettings" type:"structure"` MsSmoothGroupSettings *MsSmoothGroupSettings `locationName:"msSmoothGroupSettings" type:"structure"` RtmpGroupSettings *RtmpGroupSettings `locationName:"rtmpGroupSettings" type:"structure"` UdpGroupSettings *UdpGroupSettings `locationName:"udpGroupSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputGroupSettings"} if s.ArchiveGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.ArchiveGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ArchiveGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.FrameCaptureGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.FrameCaptureGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("FrameCaptureGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.HlsGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.HlsGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("HlsGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.MsSmoothGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.MsSmoothGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("MsSmoothGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.RtmpGroupSettings != nil { if err := s.RtmpGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("RtmpGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetArchiveGroupSettings sets the ArchiveGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetArchiveGroupSettings(v *ArchiveGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.ArchiveGroupSettings = v return s } // SetFrameCaptureGroupSettings sets the FrameCaptureGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetFrameCaptureGroupSettings(v *FrameCaptureGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.FrameCaptureGroupSettings = v return s } // SetHlsGroupSettings sets the HlsGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetHlsGroupSettings(v *HlsGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.HlsGroupSettings = v return s } // SetMsSmoothGroupSettings sets the MsSmoothGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetMsSmoothGroupSettings(v *MsSmoothGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.MsSmoothGroupSettings = v return s } // SetRtmpGroupSettings sets the RtmpGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetRtmpGroupSettings(v *RtmpGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.RtmpGroupSettings = v return s } // SetUdpGroupSettings sets the UdpGroupSettings field's value. func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetUdpGroupSettings(v *UdpGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings { s.UdpGroupSettings = v return s } // Reference to an OutputDestination ID defined in the channel type OutputLocationRef struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` DestinationRefId *string `locationName:"destinationRefId" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputLocationRef) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputLocationRef) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDestinationRefId sets the DestinationRefId field's value. func (s *OutputLocationRef) SetDestinationRefId(v string) *OutputLocationRef { s.DestinationRefId = &v return s } type OutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` ArchiveOutputSettings *ArchiveOutputSettings `locationName:"archiveOutputSettings" type:"structure"` // Frame Capture Output Settings FrameCaptureOutputSettings *FrameCaptureOutputSettings `locationName:"frameCaptureOutputSettings" type:"structure"` HlsOutputSettings *HlsOutputSettings `locationName:"hlsOutputSettings" type:"structure"` MsSmoothOutputSettings *MsSmoothOutputSettings `locationName:"msSmoothOutputSettings" type:"structure"` RtmpOutputSettings *RtmpOutputSettings `locationName:"rtmpOutputSettings" type:"structure"` UdpOutputSettings *UdpOutputSettings `locationName:"udpOutputSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *OutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputSettings"} if s.ArchiveOutputSettings != nil { if err := s.ArchiveOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ArchiveOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.HlsOutputSettings != nil { if err := s.HlsOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("HlsOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.RtmpOutputSettings != nil { if err := s.RtmpOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("RtmpOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.UdpOutputSettings != nil { if err := s.UdpOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("UdpOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetArchiveOutputSettings sets the ArchiveOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetArchiveOutputSettings(v *ArchiveOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.ArchiveOutputSettings = v return s } // SetFrameCaptureOutputSettings sets the FrameCaptureOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetFrameCaptureOutputSettings(v *FrameCaptureOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.FrameCaptureOutputSettings = v return s } // SetHlsOutputSettings sets the HlsOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetHlsOutputSettings(v *HlsOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.HlsOutputSettings = v return s } // SetMsSmoothOutputSettings sets the MsSmoothOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetMsSmoothOutputSettings(v *MsSmoothOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.MsSmoothOutputSettings = v return s } // SetRtmpOutputSettings sets the RtmpOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetRtmpOutputSettings(v *RtmpOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.RtmpOutputSettings = v return s } // SetUdpOutputSettings sets the UdpOutputSettings field's value. func (s *OutputSettings) SetUdpOutputSettings(v *UdpOutputSettings) *OutputSettings { s.UdpOutputSettings = v return s } type PassThroughSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PassThroughSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PassThroughSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type PurchaseOfferingInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Count is a required field Count *int64 `locationName:"count" min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // OfferingId is a required field OfferingId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"offeringId" type:"string" required:"true"` RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"` Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PurchaseOfferingInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PurchaseOfferingInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PurchaseOfferingInput"} if s.Count == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Count")) } if s.Count != nil && *s.Count < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Count", 1)) } if s.OfferingId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OfferingId")) } if s.OfferingId != nil && len(*s.OfferingId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OfferingId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCount sets the Count field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetCount(v int64) *PurchaseOfferingInput { s.Count = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetName(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetOfferingId(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetRequestId(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput { s.RequestId = &v return s } // SetStart sets the Start field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetStart(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput { s.Start = &v return s } type PurchaseOfferingOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Reserved resources available to use Reservation *Reservation `locationName:"reservation" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PurchaseOfferingOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PurchaseOfferingOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetReservation sets the Reservation field's value. func (s *PurchaseOfferingOutput) SetReservation(v *Reservation) *PurchaseOfferingOutput { s.Reservation = v return s } type RemixSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Mapping of input channels to output channels, with appropriate gain adjustments. // // ChannelMappings is a required field ChannelMappings []*AudioChannelMapping `locationName:"channelMappings" type:"list" required:"true"` // Number of input channels to be used. ChannelsIn *int64 `locationName:"channelsIn" min:"1" type:"integer"` // Number of output channels to be produced.Valid values: 1, 2, 4, 6, 8 ChannelsOut *int64 `locationName:"channelsOut" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RemixSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RemixSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RemixSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemixSettings"} if s.ChannelMappings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelMappings")) } if s.ChannelsIn != nil && *s.ChannelsIn < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ChannelsIn", 1)) } if s.ChannelsOut != nil && *s.ChannelsOut < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ChannelsOut", 1)) } if s.ChannelMappings != nil { for i, v := range s.ChannelMappings { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ChannelMappings", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelMappings sets the ChannelMappings field's value. func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelMappings(v []*AudioChannelMapping) *RemixSettings { s.ChannelMappings = v return s } // SetChannelsIn sets the ChannelsIn field's value. func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelsIn(v int64) *RemixSettings { s.ChannelsIn = &v return s } // SetChannelsOut sets the ChannelsOut field's value. func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelsOut(v int64) *RemixSettings { s.ChannelsOut = &v return s } // Reserved resources available to use type Reservation struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Unique reservation ARN, e.g. 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:reservation:1234567' Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` // Number of reserved resources Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"` // Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD' CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"` // Lease duration, e.g. '12' Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"` // Reservation UTC end date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. '2019-03-01T00:00:00' End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"` // One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"` // User specified reservation name Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` // Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard // VQ in US West (Oregon)' OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"` // Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321' OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"` // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"` // AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2' Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"` // Unique reservation ID, e.g. '1234567' ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"` // Resource configuration details ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"` // Reservation UTC start date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. '2018-03-01T00:00:00' Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"` // Current state of reservation, e.g. 'ACTIVE' State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"` // Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0' UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Reservation) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Reservation) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetArn(v string) *Reservation { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetCount sets the Count field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetCount(v int64) *Reservation { s.Count = &v return s } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *Reservation { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetDuration(v int64) *Reservation { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetDurationUnits(v string) *Reservation { s.DurationUnits = &v return s } // SetEnd sets the End field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetEnd(v string) *Reservation { s.End = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *Reservation { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetName(v string) *Reservation { s.Name = &v return s } // SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *Reservation { s.OfferingDescription = &v return s } // SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingId(v string) *Reservation { s.OfferingId = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingType(v string) *Reservation { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRegion sets the Region field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetRegion(v string) *Reservation { s.Region = &v return s } // SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetReservationId(v string) *Reservation { s.ReservationId = &v return s } // SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *Reservation { s.ResourceSpecification = v return s } // SetStart sets the Start field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetStart(v string) *Reservation { s.Start = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetState(v string) *Reservation { s.State = &v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *Reservation) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *Reservation { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } // Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...) type ReservationResourceSpecification struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Codec, e.g. 'AVC' Codec *string `locationName:"codec" type:"string" enum:"ReservationCodec"` // Maximum bitrate, e.g. 'MAX_20_MBPS' MaximumBitrate *string `locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string" enum:"ReservationMaximumBitrate"` // Maximum framerate, e.g. 'MAX_30_FPS' (Outputs only) MaximumFramerate *string `locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string" enum:"ReservationMaximumFramerate"` // Resolution, e.g. 'HD' Resolution *string `locationName:"resolution" type:"string" enum:"ReservationResolution"` // Resource type, 'INPUT', 'OUTPUT', or 'CHANNEL' ResourceType *string `locationName:"resourceType" type:"string" enum:"ReservationResourceType"` // Special feature, e.g. 'AUDIO_NORMALIZATION' (Channels only) SpecialFeature *string `locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string" enum:"ReservationSpecialFeature"` // Video quality, e.g. 'STANDARD' (Outputs only) VideoQuality *string `locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string" enum:"ReservationVideoQuality"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ReservationResourceSpecification) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ReservationResourceSpecification) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCodec sets the Codec field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetCodec(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.Codec = &v return s } // SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.MaximumBitrate = &v return s } // SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.MaximumFramerate = &v return s } // SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetResolution(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.Resolution = &v return s } // SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetResourceType(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.ResourceType = &v return s } // SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.SpecialFeature = &v return s } // SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value. func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification { s.VideoQuality = &v return s } type RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type RtmpGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Authentication scheme to use when connecting with CDN AuthenticationScheme *string `locationName:"authenticationScheme" type:"string" enum:"AuthenticationScheme"` // Controls behavior when content cache fills up. If remote origin server stalls // the RTMP connection and does not accept content fast enough the 'Media Cache' // will fill up. When the cache reaches the duration specified by cacheLength // the cache will stop accepting new content. If set to disconnectImmediately, // the RTMP output will force a disconnect. Clear the media cache, and reconnect // after restartDelay seconds. If set to waitForServer, the RTMP output will // wait up to 5 minutes to allow the origin server to begin accepting data again. CacheFullBehavior *string `locationName:"cacheFullBehavior" type:"string" enum:"RtmpCacheFullBehavior"` // Cache length, in seconds, is used to calculate buffer size. CacheLength *int64 `locationName:"cacheLength" min:"30" type:"integer"` // Controls the types of data that passes to onCaptionInfo outputs. If set to // 'all' then 608 and 708 carried DTVCC data will be passed. If set to 'field1AndField2608' // then DTVCC data will be stripped out, but 608 data from both fields will // be passed. If set to 'field1608' then only the data carried in 608 from field // 1 video will be passed. CaptionData *string `locationName:"captionData" type:"string" enum:"RtmpCaptionData"` // Controls the behavior of this RTMP group if input becomes unavailable.- emitOutput: // Emit a slate until input returns.- pauseOutput: Stop transmitting data until // input returns. This does not close the underlying RTMP connection. InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForRtmpOut"` // If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is // initiated. A value of 0 means never restart. RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RtmpGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RtmpGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RtmpGroupSettings"} if s.CacheLength != nil && *s.CacheLength < 30 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("CacheLength", 30)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAuthenticationScheme sets the AuthenticationScheme field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetAuthenticationScheme(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.AuthenticationScheme = &v return s } // SetCacheFullBehavior sets the CacheFullBehavior field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCacheFullBehavior(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.CacheFullBehavior = &v return s } // SetCacheLength sets the CacheLength field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCacheLength(v int64) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.CacheLength = &v return s } // SetCaptionData sets the CaptionData field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCaptionData(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.CaptionData = &v return s } // SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.InputLossAction = &v return s } // SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value. func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *RtmpGroupSettings { s.RestartDelay = &v return s } type RtmpOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the tls certificate chain to a trusted // Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause rtmps outputs with self-signed // certificates to fail. CertificateMode *string `locationName:"certificateMode" type:"string" enum:"RtmpOutputCertificateMode"` // Number of seconds to wait before retrying a connection to the Flash Media // server if the connection is lost. ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" min:"1" type:"integer"` // The RTMP endpoint excluding the stream name (eg. rtmp://host/appname). For // connection to Akamai, a username and password must be supplied. URI fields // accept format identifiers. // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Number of retry attempts. NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RtmpOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RtmpOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RtmpOutputSettings"} if s.ConnectionRetryInterval != nil && *s.ConnectionRetryInterval < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ConnectionRetryInterval", 1)) } if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCertificateMode sets the CertificateMode field's value. func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetCertificateMode(v string) *RtmpOutputSettings { s.CertificateMode = &v return s } // SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value. func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *RtmpOutputSettings { s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v return s } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *RtmpOutputSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value. func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *RtmpOutputSettings { s.NumRetries = &v return s } // Contains information on a single schedule action. type ScheduleAction struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the action, must be unique within the schedule. This name provides // the main reference to an action once it is added to the schedule. A name // is unique if it is no longer in the schedule. The schedule is automatically // cleaned up to remove actions with a start time of more than 1 hour ago (approximately) // so at that point a name can be reused. // // ActionName is a required field ActionName *string `locationName:"actionName" type:"string" required:"true"` // Settings for this schedule action. // // ScheduleActionSettings is a required field ScheduleActionSettings *ScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scheduleActionSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // The time for the action to start in the channel. // // ScheduleActionStartSettings is a required field ScheduleActionStartSettings *ScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"scheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ScheduleAction) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ScheduleAction) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ScheduleAction) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleAction"} if s.ActionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionName")) } if s.ScheduleActionSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActionSettings")) } if s.ScheduleActionStartSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActionStartSettings")) } if s.ScheduleActionSettings != nil { if err := s.ScheduleActionSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ScheduleActionSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.ScheduleActionStartSettings != nil { if err := s.ScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetActionName sets the ActionName field's value. func (s *ScheduleAction) SetActionName(v string) *ScheduleAction { s.ActionName = &v return s } // SetScheduleActionSettings sets the ScheduleActionSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleAction) SetScheduleActionSettings(v *ScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleAction { s.ScheduleActionSettings = v return s } // SetScheduleActionStartSettings sets the ScheduleActionStartSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleAction) SetScheduleActionStartSettings(v *ScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleAction { s.ScheduleActionStartSettings = v return s } // Holds the settings for a single schedule action. type ScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Settings to emit HLS metadata HlsTimedMetadataSettings *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"hlsTimedMetadataSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings to switch an input InputSwitchSettings *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"inputSwitchSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings for SCTE-35 return_to_network message Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings for SCTE-35 splice_insert message Scte35SpliceInsertSettings *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35SpliceInsertSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings for SCTE-35 time_signal message Scte35TimeSignalSettings *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35TimeSignalSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings to activate a static image overlay StaticImageActivateSettings *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"staticImageActivateSettings" type:"structure"` // Settings to deactivate a static image overlay StaticImageDeactivateSettings *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"staticImageDeactivateSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleActionSettings"} if s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings != nil { if err := s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("HlsTimedMetadataSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.InputSwitchSettings != nil { if err := s.InputSwitchSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("InputSwitchSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35SpliceInsertSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35TimeSignalSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.StaticImageActivateSettings != nil { if err := s.StaticImageActivateSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("StaticImageActivateSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetHlsTimedMetadataSettings sets the HlsTimedMetadataSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetHlsTimedMetadataSettings(v *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings = v return s } // SetInputSwitchSettings sets the InputSwitchSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetInputSwitchSettings(v *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.InputSwitchSettings = v return s } // SetScte35ReturnToNetworkSettings sets the Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35ReturnToNetworkSettings(v *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings = v return s } // SetScte35SpliceInsertSettings sets the Scte35SpliceInsertSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35SpliceInsertSettings(v *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings = v return s } // SetScte35TimeSignalSettings sets the Scte35TimeSignalSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35TimeSignalSettings(v *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings = v return s } // SetStaticImageActivateSettings sets the StaticImageActivateSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetStaticImageActivateSettings(v *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.StaticImageActivateSettings = v return s } // SetStaticImageDeactivateSettings sets the StaticImageDeactivateSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetStaticImageDeactivateSettings(v *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings { s.StaticImageDeactivateSettings = v return s } // Settings to specify the start time for an action. type ScheduleActionStartSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Holds the start time for the action. FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"fixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure"` // Specifies an action to follow for scheduling this action. FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"followModeScheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleActionStartSettings"} if s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings != nil { if err := s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings != nil { if err := s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetFixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings sets the FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings(v *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleActionStartSettings { s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings = v return s } // SetFollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings sets the FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings field's value. func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings(v *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleActionStartSettings { s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings = v return s } type Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type Scte20SourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility // bytes" fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data // present in the source content will be discarded. Convert608To708 *string `locationName:"convert608To708" type:"string" enum:"Scte20Convert608To708"` // Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to // extract captions. Unused for passthrough. Source608ChannelNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608ChannelNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte20SourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte20SourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte20SourceSettings"} if s.Source608ChannelNumber != nil && *s.Source608ChannelNumber < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608ChannelNumber", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetConvert608To708 sets the Convert608To708 field's value. func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) SetConvert608To708(v string) *Scte20SourceSettings { s.Convert608To708 = &v return s } // SetSource608ChannelNumber sets the Source608ChannelNumber field's value. func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) SetSource608ChannelNumber(v int64) *Scte20SourceSettings { s.Source608ChannelNumber = &v return s } type Scte27DestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte27DestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte27DestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type Scte27SourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The pid field is used in conjunction with the caption selector languageCode // field as follows: - Specify PID and Language: Extracts captions from that // PID; the language is "informational". - Specify PID and omit Language: Extracts // the specified PID. - Omit PID and specify Language: Extracts the specified // language, whichever PID that happens to be. - Omit PID and omit Language: // Valid only if source is DVB-Sub that is being passed through; all languages // will be passed through. Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte27SourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte27SourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte27SourceSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte27SourceSettings"} if s.Pid != nil && *s.Pid < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Pid", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetPid sets the Pid field's value. func (s *Scte27SourceSettings) SetPid(v int64) *Scte27SourceSettings { s.Pid = &v return s } // Corresponds to SCTE-35 delivery_not_restricted_flag parameter. To declare // delivery restrictions, include this element and its four "restriction" flags. // To declare that there are no restrictions, omit this element. type Scte35DeliveryRestrictions struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 archive_allowed_flag. // // ArchiveAllowedFlag is a required field ArchiveAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"archiveAllowedFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 device_restrictions parameter. // // DeviceRestrictions is a required field DeviceRestrictions *string `locationName:"deviceRestrictions" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35DeviceRestrictions"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 no_regional_blackout_flag parameter. // // NoRegionalBlackoutFlag is a required field NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 web_delivery_allowed_flag parameter. // // WebDeliveryAllowedFlag is a required field WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35DeliveryRestrictions"} if s.ArchiveAllowedFlag == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ArchiveAllowedFlag")) } if s.DeviceRestrictions == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DeviceRestrictions")) } if s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NoRegionalBlackoutFlag")) } if s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("WebDeliveryAllowedFlag")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetArchiveAllowedFlag sets the ArchiveAllowedFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetArchiveAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions { s.ArchiveAllowedFlag = &v return s } // SetDeviceRestrictions sets the DeviceRestrictions field's value. func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetDeviceRestrictions(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions { s.DeviceRestrictions = &v return s } // SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions { s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v return s } // SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions { s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v return s } // Holds one set of SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings. type Scte35Descriptor struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings. // // Scte35DescriptorSettings is a required field Scte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35DescriptorSettings `locationName:"scte35DescriptorSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35Descriptor) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35Descriptor) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35Descriptor) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35Descriptor"} if s.Scte35DescriptorSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Scte35DescriptorSettings")) } if s.Scte35DescriptorSettings != nil { if err := s.Scte35DescriptorSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35DescriptorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScte35DescriptorSettings sets the Scte35DescriptorSettings field's value. func (s *Scte35Descriptor) SetScte35DescriptorSettings(v *Scte35DescriptorSettings) *Scte35Descriptor { s.Scte35DescriptorSettings = v return s } // SCTE-35 Descriptor settings. type Scte35DescriptorSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // SCTE-35 Segmentation Descriptor. // // SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings is a required field SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor `locationName:"segmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35DescriptorSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35DescriptorSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35DescriptorSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35DescriptorSettings"} if s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings")) } if s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings != nil { if err := s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings sets the SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings field's value. func (s *Scte35DescriptorSettings) SetSegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings(v *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) *Scte35DescriptorSettings { s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings = v return s } // Settings for a SCTE-35 return_to_network message. type Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35. // // SpliceEventId is a required field SpliceEventId *int64 `locationName:"spliceEventId" type:"long" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings"} if s.SpliceEventId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SpliceEventId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSpliceEventId sets the SpliceEventId field's value. func (s *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) SetSpliceEventId(v int64) *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings { s.SpliceEventId = &v return s } // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_descriptor. type Scte35SegmentationDescriptor struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Holds the four SCTE-35 delivery restriction parameters. DeliveryRestrictions *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions `locationName:"deliveryRestrictions" type:"structure"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified // segmentation_type_id. SegmentNum *int64 `locationName:"segmentNum" type:"integer"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_cancel_indicator. // // SegmentationCancelIndicator is a required field SegmentationCancelIndicator *string `locationName:"segmentationCancelIndicator" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_duration. Optional. The duration for // the time_signal, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert seconds to ticks, multiple the // seconds by 90,000. Enter time in 90 KHz clock ticks. If you do not enter // a duration, the time_signal will continue until you insert a cancellation // message. SegmentationDuration *int64 `locationName:"segmentationDuration" type:"long"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_id. // // SegmentationEventId is a required field SegmentationEventId *int64 `locationName:"segmentationEventId" type:"long" required:"true"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_type_id. One of the segmentation_type_id // values listed in the SCTE-35 specification. On the console, enter the ID // in decimal (for example, "52"). In the CLI, API, or an SDK, enter the ID // in hex (for example, "0x34") or decimal (for example, "52"). SegmentationTypeId *int64 `locationName:"segmentationTypeId" type:"integer"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid. Enter a string containing the hexadecimal // representation of the characters that make up the SCTE-35 segmentation_upid // value. Must contain an even number of hex characters. Do not include spaces // between each hex pair. For example, the ASCII "ADS Information" becomes hex // "41445320496e666f726d6174696f6e. SegmentationUpid *string `locationName:"segmentationUpid" type:"string"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid_type. On the console, enter one // of the types listed in the SCTE-35 specification, converted to a decimal. // For example, "0x0C" hex from the specification is "12" in decimal. In the // CLI, API, or an SDK, enter one of the types listed in the SCTE-35 specification, // in either hex (for example, "0x0C" ) or in decimal (for example, "12"). SegmentationUpidType *int64 `locationName:"segmentationUpidType" type:"integer"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segments_expected. A value that is valid for the specified // segmentation_type_id. SegmentsExpected *int64 `locationName:"segmentsExpected" type:"integer"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified // segmentation_type_id. SubSegmentNum *int64 `locationName:"subSegmentNum" type:"integer"` // Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segments_expected. A value that is valid for the // specified segmentation_type_id. SubSegmentsExpected *int64 `locationName:"subSegmentsExpected" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SegmentationDescriptor"} if s.SegmentationCancelIndicator == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationCancelIndicator")) } if s.SegmentationEventId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationEventId")) } if s.DeliveryRestrictions != nil { if err := s.DeliveryRestrictions.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("DeliveryRestrictions", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDeliveryRestrictions sets the DeliveryRestrictions field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetDeliveryRestrictions(v *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.DeliveryRestrictions = v return s } // SetSegmentNum sets the SegmentNum field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentNum(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentNum = &v return s } // SetSegmentationCancelIndicator sets the SegmentationCancelIndicator field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationCancelIndicator(v string) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationCancelIndicator = &v return s } // SetSegmentationDuration sets the SegmentationDuration field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationDuration(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationDuration = &v return s } // SetSegmentationEventId sets the SegmentationEventId field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationEventId(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationEventId = &v return s } // SetSegmentationTypeId sets the SegmentationTypeId field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationTypeId(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationTypeId = &v return s } // SetSegmentationUpid sets the SegmentationUpid field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationUpid(v string) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationUpid = &v return s } // SetSegmentationUpidType sets the SegmentationUpidType field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationUpidType(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentationUpidType = &v return s } // SetSegmentsExpected sets the SegmentsExpected field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentsExpected(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SegmentsExpected = &v return s } // SetSubSegmentNum sets the SubSegmentNum field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSubSegmentNum(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SubSegmentNum = &v return s } // SetSubSegmentsExpected sets the SubSegmentsExpected field's value. func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSubSegmentsExpected(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor { s.SubSegmentsExpected = &v return s } type Scte35SpliceInsert struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail // PTS time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not // apply to OOB messages. AdAvailOffset *int64 `locationName:"adAvailOffset" type:"integer"` // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to // 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior"` // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to // 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35SpliceInsert) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35SpliceInsert) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SpliceInsert"} if s.AdAvailOffset != nil && *s.AdAvailOffset < -1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("AdAvailOffset", -1000)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdAvailOffset sets the AdAvailOffset field's value. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetAdAvailOffset(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsert { s.AdAvailOffset = &v return s } // SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35SpliceInsert { s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v return s } // SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35SpliceInsert { s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v return s } // Settings for a SCTE-35 splice_insert message. type Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Optional, the duration for the splice_insert, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert // seconds to ticks, multiple the seconds by 90,000. If you enter a duration, // there is an expectation that the downstream system can read the duration // and cue in at that time. If you do not enter a duration, the splice_insert // will continue indefinitely and there is an expectation that you will enter // a return_to_network to end the splice_insert at the appropriate time. Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"long"` // The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35. // // SpliceEventId is a required field SpliceEventId *int64 `locationName:"spliceEventId" type:"long" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings"} if s.SpliceEventId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SpliceEventId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) SetDuration(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetSpliceEventId sets the SpliceEventId field's value. func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) SetSpliceEventId(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings { s.SpliceEventId = &v return s } type Scte35TimeSignalApos struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail // PTS time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not // apply to OOB messages. AdAvailOffset *int64 `locationName:"adAvailOffset" type:"integer"` // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to // 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior"` // When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to // 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35TimeSignalApos) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35TimeSignalApos) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35TimeSignalApos"} if s.AdAvailOffset != nil && *s.AdAvailOffset < -1000 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("AdAvailOffset", -1000)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdAvailOffset sets the AdAvailOffset field's value. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetAdAvailOffset(v int64) *Scte35TimeSignalApos { s.AdAvailOffset = &v return s } // SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35TimeSignalApos { s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v return s } // SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35TimeSignalApos { s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v return s } // Settings for a SCTE-35 time_signal. type Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The list of SCTE-35 descriptors accompanying the SCTE-35 time_signal. // // Scte35Descriptors is a required field Scte35Descriptors []*Scte35Descriptor `locationName:"scte35Descriptors" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings"} if s.Scte35Descriptors == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Scte35Descriptors")) } if s.Scte35Descriptors != nil { for i, v := range s.Scte35Descriptors { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Scte35Descriptors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScte35Descriptors sets the Scte35Descriptors field's value. func (s *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35Descriptors(v []*Scte35Descriptor) *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings { s.Scte35Descriptors = v return s } type SmpteTtDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SmpteTtDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SmpteTtDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type StandardHlsSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // List all the audio groups that are used with the video output stream. Input // all the audio GROUP-IDs that are associated to the video, separate by ','. AudioRenditionSets *string `locationName:"audioRenditionSets" type:"string"` // Settings information for the .m3u8 container // // M3u8Settings is a required field M3u8Settings *M3u8Settings `locationName:"m3u8Settings" type:"structure" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StandardHlsSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StandardHlsSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *StandardHlsSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StandardHlsSettings"} if s.M3u8Settings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("M3u8Settings")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAudioRenditionSets sets the AudioRenditionSets field's value. func (s *StandardHlsSettings) SetAudioRenditionSets(v string) *StandardHlsSettings { s.AudioRenditionSets = &v return s } // SetM3u8Settings sets the M3u8Settings field's value. func (s *StandardHlsSettings) SetM3u8Settings(v *M3u8Settings) *StandardHlsSettings { s.M3u8Settings = v return s } type StartChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StartChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StartChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *StartChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartChannelInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *StartChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *StartChannelInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } type StartChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StartChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StartChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *StartChannelOutput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *StartChannelOutput { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *StartChannelOutput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *StartChannelOutput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *StartChannelOutput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *StartChannelOutput { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *StartChannelOutput { s.State = &v return s } // Settings for the action to activate a static image. type StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The duration in milliseconds for the image to remain on the video. If omitted // or set to 0 the duration is unlimited and the image will remain until it // is explicitly deactivated. Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"` // The time in milliseconds for the image to fade in. The fade-in starts at // the start time of the overlay. Default is 0 (no fade-in). FadeIn *int64 `locationName:"fadeIn" type:"integer"` // Applies only if a duration is specified. The time in milliseconds for the // image to fade out. The fade-out starts when the duration time is hit, so // it effectively extends the duration. Default is 0 (no fade-out). FadeOut *int64 `locationName:"fadeOut" type:"integer"` // The height of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay // will be scaled up or down to the specified height. Leave blank to use the // native height of the overlay. Height *int64 `locationName:"height" min:"1" type:"integer"` // The location and filename of the image file to overlay on the video. The // file must be a 32-bit BMP, PNG, or TGA file, and must not be larger (in pixels) // than the input video. // // Image is a required field Image *InputLocation `locationName:"image" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Placement of the left edge of the overlay relative to the left edge of the // video frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the left edge of the frame. If // the placement causes the overlay to extend beyond the right edge of the underlying // video, then the overlay is cropped on the right. ImageX *int64 `locationName:"imageX" type:"integer"` // Placement of the top edge of the overlay relative to the top edge of the // video frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the top edge of the frame. If // the placement causes the overlay to extend beyond the bottom edge of the // underlying video, then the overlay is cropped on the bottom. ImageY *int64 `locationName:"imageY" type:"integer"` // The number of the layer, 0 to 7. There are 8 layers that can be overlaid // on the video, each layer with a different image. The layers are in Z order, // which means that overlays with higher values of layer are inserted on top // of overlays with lower values of layer. Default is 0. Layer *int64 `locationName:"layer" type:"integer"` // Opacity of image where 0 is transparent and 100 is fully opaque. Default // is 100. Opacity *int64 `locationName:"opacity" type:"integer"` // The width of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay // will be scaled up or down to the specified width. Leave blank to use the // native width of the overlay. Width *int64 `locationName:"width" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings"} if s.Height != nil && *s.Height < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Height", 1)) } if s.Image == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Image")) } if s.Width != nil && *s.Width < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Width", 1)) } if s.Image != nil { if err := s.Image.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("Image", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetDuration(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetFadeIn sets the FadeIn field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeIn(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.FadeIn = &v return s } // SetFadeOut sets the FadeOut field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeOut(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.FadeOut = &v return s } // SetHeight sets the Height field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetHeight(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Height = &v return s } // SetImage sets the Image field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImage(v *InputLocation) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Image = v return s } // SetImageX sets the ImageX field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImageX(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.ImageX = &v return s } // SetImageY sets the ImageY field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImageY(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.ImageY = &v return s } // SetLayer sets the Layer field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetLayer(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Layer = &v return s } // SetOpacity sets the Opacity field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetOpacity(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Opacity = &v return s } // SetWidth sets the Width field's value. func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetWidth(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Width = &v return s } // Settings for the action to deactivate the image in a specific layer. type StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The time in milliseconds for the image to fade out. Default is 0 (no fade-out). FadeOut *int64 `locationName:"fadeOut" type:"integer"` // The image overlay layer to deactivate, 0 to 7. Default is 0. Layer *int64 `locationName:"layer" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetFadeOut sets the FadeOut field's value. func (s *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeOut(v int64) *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings { s.FadeOut = &v return s } // SetLayer sets the Layer field's value. func (s *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) SetLayer(v int64) *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings { s.Layer = &v return s } type StaticKeySettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The URL of the license server used for protecting content. KeyProviderServer *InputLocation `locationName:"keyProviderServer" type:"structure"` // Static key value as a 32 character hexadecimal string. // // StaticKeyValue is a required field StaticKeyValue *string `locationName:"staticKeyValue" min:"32" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StaticKeySettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StaticKeySettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *StaticKeySettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StaticKeySettings"} if s.StaticKeyValue == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("StaticKeyValue")) } if s.StaticKeyValue != nil && len(*s.StaticKeyValue) < 32 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("StaticKeyValue", 32)) } if s.KeyProviderServer != nil { if err := s.KeyProviderServer.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("KeyProviderServer", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetKeyProviderServer sets the KeyProviderServer field's value. func (s *StaticKeySettings) SetKeyProviderServer(v *InputLocation) *StaticKeySettings { s.KeyProviderServer = v return s } // SetStaticKeyValue sets the StaticKeyValue field's value. func (s *StaticKeySettings) SetStaticKeyValue(v string) *StaticKeySettings { s.StaticKeyValue = &v return s } type StopChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StopChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StopChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *StopChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopChannelInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *StopChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *StopChannelInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } type StopChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s StopChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s StopChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetArn sets the Arn field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.Arn = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *StopChannelOutput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *StopChannelOutput { s.EgressEndpoints = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *StopChannelOutput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetId sets the Id field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.Id = &v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *StopChannelOutput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *StopChannelOutput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *StopChannelOutput { s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *StopChannelOutput { s.State = &v return s } type TeletextDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TeletextDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TeletextDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } type TeletextSourceSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies the teletext page number within the data stream from which to extract // captions. Range of 0x100 (256) to 0x8FF (2303). Unused for passthrough. Should // be specified as a hexadecimal string with no "0x" prefix. PageNumber *string `locationName:"pageNumber" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TeletextSourceSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TeletextSourceSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPageNumber sets the PageNumber field's value. func (s *TeletextSourceSettings) SetPageNumber(v string) *TeletextSourceSettings { s.PageNumber = &v return s } type TimecodeConfig struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Identifies the source for the timecode that will be associated with the events // outputs.-Embedded (embedded): Initialize the output timecode with timecode // from the the source. If no embedded timecode is detected in the source, the // system falls back to using "Start at 0" (zerobased).-System Clock (systemclock): // Use the UTC time.-Start at 0 (zerobased): The time of the first frame of // the event will be 00:00:00:00. // // Source is a required field Source *string `locationName:"source" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"TimecodeConfigSource"` // Threshold in frames beyond which output timecode is resynchronized to the // input timecode. Discrepancies below this threshold are permitted to avoid // unnecessary discontinuities in the output timecode. No timecode sync when // this is not specified. SyncThreshold *int64 `locationName:"syncThreshold" min:"1" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TimecodeConfig) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TimecodeConfig) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *TimecodeConfig) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TimecodeConfig"} if s.Source == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Source")) } if s.SyncThreshold != nil && *s.SyncThreshold < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SyncThreshold", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSource sets the Source field's value. func (s *TimecodeConfig) SetSource(v string) *TimecodeConfig { s.Source = &v return s } // SetSyncThreshold sets the SyncThreshold field's value. func (s *TimecodeConfig) SetSyncThreshold(v int64) *TimecodeConfig { s.SyncThreshold = &v return s } type TtmlDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // When set to passthrough, passes through style and position information from // a TTML-like input source (TTML, SMPTE-TT, CFF-TT) to the CFF-TT output or // TTML output. StyleControl *string `locationName:"styleControl" type:"string" enum:"TtmlDestinationStyleControl"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TtmlDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TtmlDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetStyleControl sets the StyleControl field's value. func (s *TtmlDestinationSettings) SetStyleControl(v string) *TtmlDestinationSettings { s.StyleControl = &v return s } type UdpContainerSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings `locationName:"m2tsSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UdpContainerSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UdpContainerSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UdpContainerSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UdpContainerSettings"} if s.M2tsSettings != nil { if err := s.M2tsSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("M2tsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetM2tsSettings sets the M2tsSettings field's value. func (s *UdpContainerSettings) SetM2tsSettings(v *M2tsSettings) *UdpContainerSettings { s.M2tsSettings = v return s } type UdpGroupSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies behavior of last resort when input video is lost, and no more backup // inputs are available. When dropTs is selected the entire transport stream // will stop being emitted. When dropProgram is selected the program can be // dropped from the transport stream (and replaced with null packets to meet // the TS bitrate requirement). Or, when emitProgram is chosen the transport // stream will continue to be produced normally with repeat frames, black frames, // or slate frames substituted for the absent input video. InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForUdpOut"` // Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode. TimedMetadataId3Frame *string `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Frame" type:"string" enum:"UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame"` // Timed Metadata interval in seconds. TimedMetadataId3Period *int64 `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Period" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UdpGroupSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UdpGroupSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value. func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *UdpGroupSettings { s.InputLossAction = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataId3Frame sets the TimedMetadataId3Frame field's value. func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Frame(v string) *UdpGroupSettings { s.TimedMetadataId3Frame = &v return s } // SetTimedMetadataId3Period sets the TimedMetadataId3Period field's value. func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Period(v int64) *UdpGroupSettings { s.TimedMetadataId3Period = &v return s } type UdpOutputSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // UDP output buffering in milliseconds. Larger values increase latency through // the transcoder but simultaneously assist the transcoder in maintaining a // constant, low-jitter UDP/RTP output while accommodating clock recovery, input // switching, input disruptions, picture reordering, etc. BufferMsec *int64 `locationName:"bufferMsec" type:"integer"` // ContainerSettings is a required field ContainerSettings *UdpContainerSettings `locationName:"containerSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Destination address and port number for RTP or UDP packets. Can be unicast // or multicast RTP or UDP (eg. rtp://239.10.10.10:5001 or udp://10.100.100.100:5002). // // Destination is a required field Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"` // Settings for enabling and adjusting Forward Error Correction on UDP outputs. FecOutputSettings *FecOutputSettings `locationName:"fecOutputSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UdpOutputSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UdpOutputSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UdpOutputSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UdpOutputSettings"} if s.ContainerSettings == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ContainerSettings")) } if s.Destination == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination")) } if s.ContainerSettings != nil { if err := s.ContainerSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("ContainerSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.FecOutputSettings != nil { if err := s.FecOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("FecOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetBufferMsec sets the BufferMsec field's value. func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetBufferMsec(v int64) *UdpOutputSettings { s.BufferMsec = &v return s } // SetContainerSettings sets the ContainerSettings field's value. func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetContainerSettings(v *UdpContainerSettings) *UdpOutputSettings { s.ContainerSettings = v return s } // SetDestination sets the Destination field's value. func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *UdpOutputSettings { s.Destination = v return s } // SetFecOutputSettings sets the FecOutputSettings field's value. func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetFecOutputSettings(v *FecOutputSettings) *UdpOutputSettings { s.FecOutputSettings = v return s } type UpdateChannelInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // ChannelId is a required field ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"` Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"` InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"` InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"` // The log level the user wants for their channel. LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateChannelInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateChannelInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateChannelInput"} if s.ChannelId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId")) } if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1)) } if s.EncoderSettings != nil { if err := s.EncoderSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("EncoderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.InputAttachments != nil { for i, v := range s.InputAttachments { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputAttachments", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *UpdateChannelInput { s.ChannelId = &v return s } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *UpdateChannelInput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *UpdateChannelInput { s.EncoderSettings = v return s } // SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *UpdateChannelInput { s.InputAttachments = v return s } // SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *UpdateChannelInput { s.InputSpecification = v return s } // SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetLogLevel(v string) *UpdateChannelInput { s.LogLevel = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateChannelInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *UpdateChannelInput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } type UpdateChannelOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Channel *Channel `locationName:"channel" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateChannelOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateChannelOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetChannel sets the Channel field's value. func (s *UpdateChannelOutput) SetChannel(v *Channel) *UpdateChannelOutput { s.Channel = v return s } type UpdateInputInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Destinations []*InputDestinationRequest `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"` // InputId is a required field InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"` InputSecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"` MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlowRequest `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"` Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"` RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"` Sources []*InputSourceRequest `locationName:"sources" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateInputInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateInputInput"} if s.InputId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId")) } if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestinationRequest) *UpdateInputInput { s.Destinations = v return s } // SetInputId sets the InputId field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *UpdateInputInput { s.InputId = &v return s } // SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*string) *UpdateInputInput { s.InputSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlowRequest) *UpdateInputInput { s.MediaConnectFlows = v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateInputInput { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *UpdateInputInput { s.RoleArn = &v return s } // SetSources sets the Sources field's value. func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetSources(v []*InputSourceRequest) *UpdateInputInput { s.Sources = v return s } type UpdateInputOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Input *Input `locationName:"input" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetInput sets the Input field's value. func (s *UpdateInputOutput) SetInput(v *Input) *UpdateInputOutput { s.Input = v return s } type UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // InputSecurityGroupId is a required field InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"` WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput"} if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId")) } if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1)) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value. func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput { s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v return s } // SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value. func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput { s.WhitelistRules = v return s } type UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An Input Security Group SecurityGroup *InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"securityGroup" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSecurityGroup sets the SecurityGroup field's value. func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetSecurityGroup(v *InputSecurityGroup) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput { s.SecurityGroup = v return s } type ValidationError struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` ElementPath *string `locationName:"elementPath" type:"string"` ErrorMessage *string `locationName:"errorMessage" type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ValidationError) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ValidationError) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetElementPath sets the ElementPath field's value. func (s *ValidationError) SetElementPath(v string) *ValidationError { s.ElementPath = &v return s } // SetErrorMessage sets the ErrorMessage field's value. func (s *ValidationError) SetErrorMessage(v string) *ValidationError { s.ErrorMessage = &v return s } type VideoCodecSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Frame Capture Settings FrameCaptureSettings *FrameCaptureSettings `locationName:"frameCaptureSettings" type:"structure"` H264Settings *H264Settings `locationName:"h264Settings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoCodecSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoCodecSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *VideoCodecSettings) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "VideoCodecSettings"} if s.FrameCaptureSettings != nil { if err := s.FrameCaptureSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("FrameCaptureSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if s.H264Settings != nil { if err := s.H264Settings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("H264Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetFrameCaptureSettings sets the FrameCaptureSettings field's value. func (s *VideoCodecSettings) SetFrameCaptureSettings(v *FrameCaptureSettings) *VideoCodecSettings { s.FrameCaptureSettings = v return s } // SetH264Settings sets the H264Settings field's value. func (s *VideoCodecSettings) SetH264Settings(v *H264Settings) *VideoCodecSettings { s.H264Settings = v return s } // Video settings for this stream. type VideoDescription struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Video codec settings. CodecSettings *VideoCodecSettings `locationName:"codecSettings" type:"structure"` // Output video height, in pixels. Must be an even number. For most codecs, // you can leave this field and width blank in order to use the height and width // (resolution) from the source. Note, however, that leaving blank is not recommended. // For the Frame Capture codec, height and width are required. Height *int64 `locationName:"height" type:"integer"` // The name of this VideoDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely // identify this Description. Description names should be unique within this // Live Event. // // Name is a required field Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"` // Indicates how to respond to the AFD values in the input stream. RESPOND causes // input video to be clipped, depending on the AFD value, input display aspect // ratio, and output display aspect ratio, and (except for FRAMECAPTURE codec) // includes the values in the output. PASSTHROUGH (does not apply to FRAMECAPTURE // codec) ignores the AFD values and includes the values in the output, so input // video is not clipped. NONE ignores the AFD values and does not include the // values through to the output, so input video is not clipped. RespondToAfd *string `locationName:"respondToAfd" type:"string" enum:"VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd"` // STRETCHTOOUTPUT configures the output position to stretch the video to the // specified output resolution (height and width). This option will override // any position value. DEFAULT may insert black boxes (pillar boxes or letter // boxes) around the video to provide the specified output resolution. ScalingBehavior *string `locationName:"scalingBehavior" type:"string" enum:"VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior"` // Changes the strength of the anti-alias filter used for scaling. 0 is the // softest setting, 100 is the sharpest. A setting of 50 is recommended for // most content. Sharpness *int64 `locationName:"sharpness" type:"integer"` // Output video width, in pixels. Must be an even number. For most codecs, you // can leave this field and height blank in order to use the height and width // (resolution) from the source. Note, however, that leaving blank is not recommended. // For the Frame Capture codec, height and width are required. Width *int64 `locationName:"width" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoDescription) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoDescription) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *VideoDescription) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "VideoDescription"} if s.Name == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name")) } if s.CodecSettings != nil { if err := s.CodecSettings.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested("CodecSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCodecSettings sets the CodecSettings field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetCodecSettings(v *VideoCodecSettings) *VideoDescription { s.CodecSettings = v return s } // SetHeight sets the Height field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetHeight(v int64) *VideoDescription { s.Height = &v return s } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetName(v string) *VideoDescription { s.Name = &v return s } // SetRespondToAfd sets the RespondToAfd field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetRespondToAfd(v string) *VideoDescription { s.RespondToAfd = &v return s } // SetScalingBehavior sets the ScalingBehavior field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetScalingBehavior(v string) *VideoDescription { s.ScalingBehavior = &v return s } // SetSharpness sets the Sharpness field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetSharpness(v int64) *VideoDescription { s.Sharpness = &v return s } // SetWidth sets the Width field's value. func (s *VideoDescription) SetWidth(v int64) *VideoDescription { s.Width = &v return s } // Specifies a particular video stream within an input source. An input may // have only a single video selector. type VideoSelector struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies the colorspace of an input. This setting works in tandem with colorSpaceConversion // to determine if any conversion will be performed. ColorSpace *string `locationName:"colorSpace" type:"string" enum:"VideoSelectorColorSpace"` // Applies only if colorSpace is a value other than follow. This field controls // how the value in the colorSpace field will be used. fallback means that when // the input does include color space data, that data will be used, but when // the input has no color space data, the value in colorSpace will be used. // Choose fallback if your input is sometimes missing color space data, but // when it does have color space data, that data is correct. force means to // always use the value in colorSpace. Choose force if your input usually has // no color space data or might have unreliable color space data. ColorSpaceUsage *string `locationName:"colorSpaceUsage" type:"string" enum:"VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage"` // The video selector settings. SelectorSettings *VideoSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoSelector) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoSelector) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetColorSpace sets the ColorSpace field's value. func (s *VideoSelector) SetColorSpace(v string) *VideoSelector { s.ColorSpace = &v return s } // SetColorSpaceUsage sets the ColorSpaceUsage field's value. func (s *VideoSelector) SetColorSpaceUsage(v string) *VideoSelector { s.ColorSpaceUsage = &v return s } // SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value. func (s *VideoSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *VideoSelectorSettings) *VideoSelector { s.SelectorSettings = v return s } type VideoSelectorPid struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Selects a specific PID from within a video source. Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorPid) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorPid) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetPid sets the Pid field's value. func (s *VideoSelectorPid) SetPid(v int64) *VideoSelectorPid { s.Pid = &v return s } type VideoSelectorProgramId struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Selects a specific program from within a multi-program transport stream. // If the program doesn't exist, the first program within the transport stream // will be selected by default. ProgramId *int64 `locationName:"programId" type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorProgramId) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorProgramId) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetProgramId sets the ProgramId field's value. func (s *VideoSelectorProgramId) SetProgramId(v int64) *VideoSelectorProgramId { s.ProgramId = &v return s } type VideoSelectorSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` VideoSelectorPid *VideoSelectorPid `locationName:"videoSelectorPid" type:"structure"` VideoSelectorProgramId *VideoSelectorProgramId `locationName:"videoSelectorProgramId" type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VideoSelectorSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetVideoSelectorPid sets the VideoSelectorPid field's value. func (s *VideoSelectorSettings) SetVideoSelectorPid(v *VideoSelectorPid) *VideoSelectorSettings { s.VideoSelectorPid = v return s } // SetVideoSelectorProgramId sets the VideoSelectorProgramId field's value. func (s *VideoSelectorSettings) SetVideoSelectorProgramId(v *VideoSelectorProgramId) *VideoSelectorSettings { s.VideoSelectorProgramId = v return s } type WebvttDestinationSettings struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s WebvttDestinationSettings) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s WebvttDestinationSettings) GoString() string { return s.String() } const ( // AacCodingModeAdReceiverMix is a AacCodingMode enum value AacCodingModeAdReceiverMix = "AD_RECEIVER_MIX" // AacCodingModeCodingMode10 is a AacCodingMode enum value AacCodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0" // AacCodingModeCodingMode11 is a AacCodingMode enum value AacCodingModeCodingMode11 = "CODING_MODE_1_1" // AacCodingModeCodingMode20 is a AacCodingMode enum value AacCodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0" // AacCodingModeCodingMode51 is a AacCodingMode enum value AacCodingModeCodingMode51 = "CODING_MODE_5_1" ) const ( // AacInputTypeBroadcasterMixedAd is a AacInputType enum value AacInputTypeBroadcasterMixedAd = "BROADCASTER_MIXED_AD" // AacInputTypeNormal is a AacInputType enum value AacInputTypeNormal = "NORMAL" ) const ( // AacProfileHev1 is a AacProfile enum value AacProfileHev1 = "HEV1" // AacProfileHev2 is a AacProfile enum value AacProfileHev2 = "HEV2" // AacProfileLc is a AacProfile enum value AacProfileLc = "LC" ) const ( // AacRateControlModeCbr is a AacRateControlMode enum value AacRateControlModeCbr = "CBR" // AacRateControlModeVbr is a AacRateControlMode enum value AacRateControlModeVbr = "VBR" ) const ( // AacRawFormatLatmLoas is a AacRawFormat enum value AacRawFormatLatmLoas = "LATM_LOAS" // AacRawFormatNone is a AacRawFormat enum value AacRawFormatNone = "NONE" ) const ( // AacSpecMpeg2 is a AacSpec enum value AacSpecMpeg2 = "MPEG2" // AacSpecMpeg4 is a AacSpec enum value AacSpecMpeg4 = "MPEG4" ) const ( // AacVbrQualityHigh is a AacVbrQuality enum value AacVbrQualityHigh = "HIGH" // AacVbrQualityLow is a AacVbrQuality enum value AacVbrQualityLow = "LOW" // AacVbrQualityMediumHigh is a AacVbrQuality enum value AacVbrQualityMediumHigh = "MEDIUM_HIGH" // AacVbrQualityMediumLow is a AacVbrQuality enum value AacVbrQualityMediumLow = "MEDIUM_LOW" ) const ( // Ac3BitstreamModeCommentary is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeCommentary = "COMMENTARY" // Ac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain = "COMPLETE_MAIN" // Ac3BitstreamModeDialogue is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeDialogue = "DIALOGUE" // Ac3BitstreamModeEmergency is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeEmergency = "EMERGENCY" // Ac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED" // Ac3BitstreamModeMusicAndEffects is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeMusicAndEffects = "MUSIC_AND_EFFECTS" // Ac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED" // Ac3BitstreamModeVoiceOver is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value Ac3BitstreamModeVoiceOver = "VOICE_OVER" ) const ( // Ac3CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value Ac3CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0" // Ac3CodingModeCodingMode11 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value Ac3CodingModeCodingMode11 = "CODING_MODE_1_1" // Ac3CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value Ac3CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0" // Ac3CodingModeCodingMode32Lfe is a Ac3CodingMode enum value Ac3CodingModeCodingMode32Lfe = "CODING_MODE_3_2_LFE" ) const ( // Ac3DrcProfileFilmStandard is a Ac3DrcProfile enum value Ac3DrcProfileFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD" // Ac3DrcProfileNone is a Ac3DrcProfile enum value Ac3DrcProfileNone = "NONE" ) const ( // Ac3LfeFilterDisabled is a Ac3LfeFilter enum value Ac3LfeFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // Ac3LfeFilterEnabled is a Ac3LfeFilter enum value Ac3LfeFilterEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // Ac3MetadataControlFollowInput is a Ac3MetadataControl enum value Ac3MetadataControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT" // Ac3MetadataControlUseConfigured is a Ac3MetadataControl enum value Ac3MetadataControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // AfdSignalingAuto is a AfdSignaling enum value AfdSignalingAuto = "AUTO" // AfdSignalingFixed is a AfdSignaling enum value AfdSignalingFixed = "FIXED" // AfdSignalingNone is a AfdSignaling enum value AfdSignalingNone = "NONE" ) const ( // AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlFollowInput is a AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl enum value AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT" // AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlUseConfigured is a AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl enum value AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlFollowInput is a AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl enum value AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT" // AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlUseConfigured is a AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl enum value AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyLoose is a AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy enum value AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyLoose = "LOOSE" // AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyStrict is a AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy enum value AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyStrict = "STRICT" ) const ( // AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17701 is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithm enum value AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17701 = "ITU_1770_1" // AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17702 is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithm enum value AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17702 = "ITU_1770_2" ) const ( // AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControlCorrectAudio is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl enum value AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControlCorrectAudio = "CORRECT_AUDIO" ) const ( // AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelect is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelect = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT" // AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelectDefault is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelectDefault = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT_DEFAULT" // AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioNotAutoSelect is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioNotAutoSelect = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_NOT_AUTO_SELECT" // AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAudioOnlyVariantStream is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAudioOnlyVariantStream = "AUDIO_ONLY_VARIANT_STREAM" ) const ( // AudioTypeCleanEffects is a AudioType enum value AudioTypeCleanEffects = "CLEAN_EFFECTS" // AudioTypeHearingImpaired is a AudioType enum value AudioTypeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED" // AudioTypeUndefined is a AudioType enum value AudioTypeUndefined = "UNDEFINED" // AudioTypeVisualImpairedCommentary is a AudioType enum value AudioTypeVisualImpairedCommentary = "VISUAL_IMPAIRED_COMMENTARY" ) const ( // AuthenticationSchemeAkamai is a AuthenticationScheme enum value AuthenticationSchemeAkamai = "AKAMAI" // AuthenticationSchemeCommon is a AuthenticationScheme enum value AuthenticationSchemeCommon = "COMMON" ) const ( // AvailBlankingStateDisabled is a AvailBlankingState enum value AvailBlankingStateDisabled = "DISABLED" // AvailBlankingStateEnabled is a AvailBlankingState enum value AvailBlankingStateEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutDisabled is a BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout enum value BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutDisabled = "DISABLED" // BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutEnabled is a BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout enum value BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // BlackoutSlateStateDisabled is a BlackoutSlateState enum value BlackoutSlateStateDisabled = "DISABLED" // BlackoutSlateStateEnabled is a BlackoutSlateState enum value BlackoutSlateStateEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // BurnInAlignmentCentered is a BurnInAlignment enum value BurnInAlignmentCentered = "CENTERED" // BurnInAlignmentLeft is a BurnInAlignment enum value BurnInAlignmentLeft = "LEFT" // BurnInAlignmentSmart is a BurnInAlignment enum value BurnInAlignmentSmart = "SMART" ) const ( // BurnInBackgroundColorBlack is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value BurnInBackgroundColorBlack = "BLACK" // BurnInBackgroundColorNone is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value BurnInBackgroundColorNone = "NONE" // BurnInBackgroundColorWhite is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value BurnInBackgroundColorWhite = "WHITE" ) const ( // BurnInFontColorBlack is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorBlack = "BLACK" // BurnInFontColorBlue is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorBlue = "BLUE" // BurnInFontColorGreen is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorGreen = "GREEN" // BurnInFontColorRed is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorRed = "RED" // BurnInFontColorWhite is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorWhite = "WHITE" // BurnInFontColorYellow is a BurnInFontColor enum value BurnInFontColorYellow = "YELLOW" ) const ( // BurnInOutlineColorBlack is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorBlack = "BLACK" // BurnInOutlineColorBlue is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorBlue = "BLUE" // BurnInOutlineColorGreen is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorGreen = "GREEN" // BurnInOutlineColorRed is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorRed = "RED" // BurnInOutlineColorWhite is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorWhite = "WHITE" // BurnInOutlineColorYellow is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value BurnInOutlineColorYellow = "YELLOW" ) const ( // BurnInShadowColorBlack is a BurnInShadowColor enum value BurnInShadowColorBlack = "BLACK" // BurnInShadowColorNone is a BurnInShadowColor enum value BurnInShadowColorNone = "NONE" // BurnInShadowColorWhite is a BurnInShadowColor enum value BurnInShadowColorWhite = "WHITE" ) const ( // BurnInTeletextGridControlFixed is a BurnInTeletextGridControl enum value BurnInTeletextGridControlFixed = "FIXED" // BurnInTeletextGridControlScaled is a BurnInTeletextGridControl enum value BurnInTeletextGridControlScaled = "SCALED" ) const ( // ChannelStateCreating is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateCreating = "CREATING" // ChannelStateCreateFailed is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateCreateFailed = "CREATE_FAILED" // ChannelStateIdle is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateIdle = "IDLE" // ChannelStateStarting is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateStarting = "STARTING" // ChannelStateRunning is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateRunning = "RUNNING" // ChannelStateRecovering is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateRecovering = "RECOVERING" // ChannelStateStopping is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateStopping = "STOPPING" // ChannelStateDeleting is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateDeleting = "DELETING" // ChannelStateDeleted is a ChannelState enum value ChannelStateDeleted = "DELETED" ) const ( // DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollow is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollow = "SDT_FOLLOW" // DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollowIfPresent is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollowIfPresent = "SDT_FOLLOW_IF_PRESENT" // DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtManual is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtManual = "SDT_MANUAL" // DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtNone is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtNone = "SDT_NONE" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationAlignmentCentered is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value DvbSubDestinationAlignmentCentered = "CENTERED" // DvbSubDestinationAlignmentLeft is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value DvbSubDestinationAlignmentLeft = "LEFT" // DvbSubDestinationAlignmentSmart is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value DvbSubDestinationAlignmentSmart = "SMART" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorBlack = "BLACK" // DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorNone is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorNone = "NONE" // DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorWhite = "WHITE" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlack = "BLACK" // DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlue is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlue = "BLUE" // DvbSubDestinationFontColorGreen is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorGreen = "GREEN" // DvbSubDestinationFontColorRed is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorRed = "RED" // DvbSubDestinationFontColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorWhite = "WHITE" // DvbSubDestinationFontColorYellow is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value DvbSubDestinationFontColorYellow = "YELLOW" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlack = "BLACK" // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlue is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlue = "BLUE" // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorGreen is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorGreen = "GREEN" // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorRed is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorRed = "RED" // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorWhite = "WHITE" // DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorYellow is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorYellow = "YELLOW" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationShadowColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value DvbSubDestinationShadowColorBlack = "BLACK" // DvbSubDestinationShadowColorNone is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value DvbSubDestinationShadowColorNone = "NONE" // DvbSubDestinationShadowColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value DvbSubDestinationShadowColorWhite = "WHITE" ) const ( // DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlFixed is a DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl enum value DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlFixed = "FIXED" // DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlScaled is a DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl enum value DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlScaled = "SCALED" ) const ( // Eac3AttenuationControlAttenuate3Db is a Eac3AttenuationControl enum value Eac3AttenuationControlAttenuate3Db = "ATTENUATE_3_DB" // Eac3AttenuationControlNone is a Eac3AttenuationControl enum value Eac3AttenuationControlNone = "NONE" ) const ( // Eac3BitstreamModeCommentary is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value Eac3BitstreamModeCommentary = "COMMENTARY" // Eac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value Eac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain = "COMPLETE_MAIN" // Eac3BitstreamModeEmergency is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value Eac3BitstreamModeEmergency = "EMERGENCY" // Eac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value Eac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED" // Eac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value Eac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED" ) const ( // Eac3CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value Eac3CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0" // Eac3CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value Eac3CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0" // Eac3CodingModeCodingMode32 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value Eac3CodingModeCodingMode32 = "CODING_MODE_3_2" ) const ( // Eac3DcFilterDisabled is a Eac3DcFilter enum value Eac3DcFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // Eac3DcFilterEnabled is a Eac3DcFilter enum value Eac3DcFilterEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // Eac3DrcLineFilmLight is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineFilmLight = "FILM_LIGHT" // Eac3DrcLineFilmStandard is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD" // Eac3DrcLineMusicLight is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineMusicLight = "MUSIC_LIGHT" // Eac3DrcLineMusicStandard is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineMusicStandard = "MUSIC_STANDARD" // Eac3DrcLineNone is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineNone = "NONE" // Eac3DrcLineSpeech is a Eac3DrcLine enum value Eac3DrcLineSpeech = "SPEECH" ) const ( // Eac3DrcRfFilmLight is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfFilmLight = "FILM_LIGHT" // Eac3DrcRfFilmStandard is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD" // Eac3DrcRfMusicLight is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfMusicLight = "MUSIC_LIGHT" // Eac3DrcRfMusicStandard is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfMusicStandard = "MUSIC_STANDARD" // Eac3DrcRfNone is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfNone = "NONE" // Eac3DrcRfSpeech is a Eac3DrcRf enum value Eac3DrcRfSpeech = "SPEECH" ) const ( // Eac3LfeControlLfe is a Eac3LfeControl enum value Eac3LfeControlLfe = "LFE" // Eac3LfeControlNoLfe is a Eac3LfeControl enum value Eac3LfeControlNoLfe = "NO_LFE" ) const ( // Eac3LfeFilterDisabled is a Eac3LfeFilter enum value Eac3LfeFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // Eac3LfeFilterEnabled is a Eac3LfeFilter enum value Eac3LfeFilterEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // Eac3MetadataControlFollowInput is a Eac3MetadataControl enum value Eac3MetadataControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT" // Eac3MetadataControlUseConfigured is a Eac3MetadataControl enum value Eac3MetadataControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // Eac3PassthroughControlNoPassthrough is a Eac3PassthroughControl enum value Eac3PassthroughControlNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" // Eac3PassthroughControlWhenPossible is a Eac3PassthroughControl enum value Eac3PassthroughControlWhenPossible = "WHEN_POSSIBLE" ) const ( // Eac3PhaseControlNoShift is a Eac3PhaseControl enum value Eac3PhaseControlNoShift = "NO_SHIFT" // Eac3PhaseControlShift90Degrees is a Eac3PhaseControl enum value Eac3PhaseControlShift90Degrees = "SHIFT_90_DEGREES" ) const ( // Eac3StereoDownmixDpl2 is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value Eac3StereoDownmixDpl2 = "DPL2" // Eac3StereoDownmixLoRo is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value Eac3StereoDownmixLoRo = "LO_RO" // Eac3StereoDownmixLtRt is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value Eac3StereoDownmixLtRt = "LT_RT" // Eac3StereoDownmixNotIndicated is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value Eac3StereoDownmixNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED" ) const ( // Eac3SurroundExModeDisabled is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value Eac3SurroundExModeDisabled = "DISABLED" // Eac3SurroundExModeEnabled is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value Eac3SurroundExModeEnabled = "ENABLED" // Eac3SurroundExModeNotIndicated is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value Eac3SurroundExModeNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED" ) const ( // Eac3SurroundModeDisabled is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value Eac3SurroundModeDisabled = "DISABLED" // Eac3SurroundModeEnabled is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value Eac3SurroundModeEnabled = "ENABLED" // Eac3SurroundModeNotIndicated is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value Eac3SurroundModeNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED" ) const ( // EmbeddedConvert608To708Disabled is a EmbeddedConvert608To708 enum value EmbeddedConvert608To708Disabled = "DISABLED" // EmbeddedConvert608To708Upconvert is a EmbeddedConvert608To708 enum value EmbeddedConvert608To708Upconvert = "UPCONVERT" ) const ( // EmbeddedScte20DetectionAuto is a EmbeddedScte20Detection enum value EmbeddedScte20DetectionAuto = "AUTO" // EmbeddedScte20DetectionOff is a EmbeddedScte20Detection enum value EmbeddedScte20DetectionOff = "OFF" ) const ( // FecOutputIncludeFecColumn is a FecOutputIncludeFec enum value FecOutputIncludeFecColumn = "COLUMN" // FecOutputIncludeFecColumnAndRow is a FecOutputIncludeFec enum value FecOutputIncludeFecColumnAndRow = "COLUMN_AND_ROW" ) const ( // FixedAfdAfd0000 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd0000 = "AFD_0000" // FixedAfdAfd0010 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd0010 = "AFD_0010" // FixedAfdAfd0011 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd0011 = "AFD_0011" // FixedAfdAfd0100 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd0100 = "AFD_0100" // FixedAfdAfd1000 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1000 = "AFD_1000" // FixedAfdAfd1001 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1001 = "AFD_1001" // FixedAfdAfd1010 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1010 = "AFD_1010" // FixedAfdAfd1011 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1011 = "AFD_1011" // FixedAfdAfd1101 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1101 = "AFD_1101" // FixedAfdAfd1110 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1110 = "AFD_1110" // FixedAfdAfd1111 is a FixedAfd enum value FixedAfdAfd1111 = "AFD_1111" ) // Follow reference point. const ( // FollowPointEnd is a FollowPoint enum value FollowPointEnd = "END" // FollowPointStart is a FollowPoint enum value FollowPointStart = "START" ) const ( // GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionNone is a GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction enum value GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionNone = "NONE" // GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionSwitchAndLoopInputs is a GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction enum value GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionSwitchAndLoopInputs = "SWITCH_AND_LOOP_INPUTS" ) const ( // GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsDisabled is a GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs enum value GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsDisabled = "DISABLED" // GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsEnabled is a GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs enum value GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceInputClock is a GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource enum value GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceInputClock = "INPUT_CLOCK" // GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceSystemClock is a GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource enum value GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceSystemClock = "SYSTEM_CLOCK" ) const ( // H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigh is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigh = "HIGH" // H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigher is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigher = "HIGHER" // H264AdaptiveQuantizationLow is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationLow = "LOW" // H264AdaptiveQuantizationMax is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationMax = "MAX" // H264AdaptiveQuantizationMedium is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationMedium = "MEDIUM" // H264AdaptiveQuantizationOff is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value H264AdaptiveQuantizationOff = "OFF" ) const ( // H264ColorMetadataIgnore is a H264ColorMetadata enum value H264ColorMetadataIgnore = "IGNORE" // H264ColorMetadataInsert is a H264ColorMetadata enum value H264ColorMetadataInsert = "INSERT" ) const ( // H264EntropyEncodingCabac is a H264EntropyEncoding enum value H264EntropyEncodingCabac = "CABAC" // H264EntropyEncodingCavlc is a H264EntropyEncoding enum value H264EntropyEncodingCavlc = "CAVLC" ) const ( // H264FlickerAqDisabled is a H264FlickerAq enum value H264FlickerAqDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264FlickerAqEnabled is a H264FlickerAq enum value H264FlickerAqEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // H264FramerateControlInitializeFromSource is a H264FramerateControl enum value H264FramerateControlInitializeFromSource = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE" // H264FramerateControlSpecified is a H264FramerateControl enum value H264FramerateControlSpecified = "SPECIFIED" ) const ( // H264GopBReferenceDisabled is a H264GopBReference enum value H264GopBReferenceDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264GopBReferenceEnabled is a H264GopBReference enum value H264GopBReferenceEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // H264GopSizeUnitsFrames is a H264GopSizeUnits enum value H264GopSizeUnitsFrames = "FRAMES" // H264GopSizeUnitsSeconds is a H264GopSizeUnits enum value H264GopSizeUnitsSeconds = "SECONDS" ) const ( // H264LevelH264Level1 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level1 = "H264_LEVEL_1" // H264LevelH264Level11 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level11 = "H264_LEVEL_1_1" // H264LevelH264Level12 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level12 = "H264_LEVEL_1_2" // H264LevelH264Level13 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level13 = "H264_LEVEL_1_3" // H264LevelH264Level2 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level2 = "H264_LEVEL_2" // H264LevelH264Level21 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level21 = "H264_LEVEL_2_1" // H264LevelH264Level22 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level22 = "H264_LEVEL_2_2" // H264LevelH264Level3 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level3 = "H264_LEVEL_3" // H264LevelH264Level31 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level31 = "H264_LEVEL_3_1" // H264LevelH264Level32 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level32 = "H264_LEVEL_3_2" // H264LevelH264Level4 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level4 = "H264_LEVEL_4" // H264LevelH264Level41 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level41 = "H264_LEVEL_4_1" // H264LevelH264Level42 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level42 = "H264_LEVEL_4_2" // H264LevelH264Level5 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level5 = "H264_LEVEL_5" // H264LevelH264Level51 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level51 = "H264_LEVEL_5_1" // H264LevelH264Level52 is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264Level52 = "H264_LEVEL_5_2" // H264LevelH264LevelAuto is a H264Level enum value H264LevelH264LevelAuto = "H264_LEVEL_AUTO" ) const ( // H264LookAheadRateControlHigh is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value H264LookAheadRateControlHigh = "HIGH" // H264LookAheadRateControlLow is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value H264LookAheadRateControlLow = "LOW" // H264LookAheadRateControlMedium is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value H264LookAheadRateControlMedium = "MEDIUM" ) const ( // H264ParControlInitializeFromSource is a H264ParControl enum value H264ParControlInitializeFromSource = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE" // H264ParControlSpecified is a H264ParControl enum value H264ParControlSpecified = "SPECIFIED" ) const ( // H264ProfileBaseline is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileBaseline = "BASELINE" // H264ProfileHigh is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileHigh = "HIGH" // H264ProfileHigh10bit is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileHigh10bit = "HIGH_10BIT" // H264ProfileHigh422 is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileHigh422 = "HIGH_422" // H264ProfileHigh42210bit is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileHigh42210bit = "HIGH_422_10BIT" // H264ProfileMain is a H264Profile enum value H264ProfileMain = "MAIN" ) const ( // H264RateControlModeCbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value H264RateControlModeCbr = "CBR" // H264RateControlModeQvbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value H264RateControlModeQvbr = "QVBR" // H264RateControlModeVbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value H264RateControlModeVbr = "VBR" ) const ( // H264ScanTypeInterlaced is a H264ScanType enum value H264ScanTypeInterlaced = "INTERLACED" // H264ScanTypeProgressive is a H264ScanType enum value H264ScanTypeProgressive = "PROGRESSIVE" ) const ( // H264SceneChangeDetectDisabled is a H264SceneChangeDetect enum value H264SceneChangeDetectDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264SceneChangeDetectEnabled is a H264SceneChangeDetect enum value H264SceneChangeDetectEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // H264SpatialAqDisabled is a H264SpatialAq enum value H264SpatialAqDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264SpatialAqEnabled is a H264SpatialAq enum value H264SpatialAqEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // H264SubGopLengthDynamic is a H264SubGopLength enum value H264SubGopLengthDynamic = "DYNAMIC" // H264SubGopLengthFixed is a H264SubGopLength enum value H264SubGopLengthFixed = "FIXED" ) const ( // H264SyntaxDefault is a H264Syntax enum value H264SyntaxDefault = "DEFAULT" // H264SyntaxRp2027 is a H264Syntax enum value H264SyntaxRp2027 = "RP2027" ) const ( // H264TemporalAqDisabled is a H264TemporalAq enum value H264TemporalAqDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264TemporalAqEnabled is a H264TemporalAq enum value H264TemporalAqEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled is a H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior enum value H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled = "DISABLED" // H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei is a H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior enum value H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei = "PIC_TIMING_SEI" ) const ( // HlsAdMarkersAdobe is a HlsAdMarkers enum value HlsAdMarkersAdobe = "ADOBE" // HlsAdMarkersElemental is a HlsAdMarkers enum value HlsAdMarkersElemental = "ELEMENTAL" // HlsAdMarkersElementalScte35 is a HlsAdMarkers enum value HlsAdMarkersElementalScte35 = "ELEMENTAL_SCTE35" ) const ( // HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeChunked is a HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode enum value HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeChunked = "CHUNKED" // HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeNonChunked is a HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode enum value HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeNonChunked = "NON_CHUNKED" ) const ( // HlsCaptionLanguageSettingInsert is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value HlsCaptionLanguageSettingInsert = "INSERT" // HlsCaptionLanguageSettingNone is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value HlsCaptionLanguageSettingNone = "NONE" // HlsCaptionLanguageSettingOmit is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value HlsCaptionLanguageSettingOmit = "OMIT" ) const ( // HlsClientCacheDisabled is a HlsClientCache enum value HlsClientCacheDisabled = "DISABLED" // HlsClientCacheEnabled is a HlsClientCache enum value HlsClientCacheEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // HlsCodecSpecificationRfc4281 is a HlsCodecSpecification enum value HlsCodecSpecificationRfc4281 = "RFC_4281" // HlsCodecSpecificationRfc6381 is a HlsCodecSpecification enum value HlsCodecSpecificationRfc6381 = "RFC_6381" ) const ( // HlsDirectoryStructureSingleDirectory is a HlsDirectoryStructure enum value HlsDirectoryStructureSingleDirectory = "SINGLE_DIRECTORY" // HlsDirectoryStructureSubdirectoryPerStream is a HlsDirectoryStructure enum value HlsDirectoryStructureSubdirectoryPerStream = "SUBDIRECTORY_PER_STREAM" ) const ( // HlsEncryptionTypeAes128 is a HlsEncryptionType enum value HlsEncryptionTypeAes128 = "AES128" // HlsEncryptionTypeSampleAes is a HlsEncryptionType enum value HlsEncryptionTypeSampleAes = "SAMPLE_AES" ) const ( // HlsIvInManifestExclude is a HlsIvInManifest enum value HlsIvInManifestExclude = "EXCLUDE" // HlsIvInManifestInclude is a HlsIvInManifest enum value HlsIvInManifestInclude = "INCLUDE" ) const ( // HlsIvSourceExplicit is a HlsIvSource enum value HlsIvSourceExplicit = "EXPLICIT" // HlsIvSourceFollowsSegmentNumber is a HlsIvSource enum value HlsIvSourceFollowsSegmentNumber = "FOLLOWS_SEGMENT_NUMBER" ) const ( // HlsManifestCompressionGzip is a HlsManifestCompression enum value HlsManifestCompressionGzip = "GZIP" // HlsManifestCompressionNone is a HlsManifestCompression enum value HlsManifestCompressionNone = "NONE" ) const ( // HlsManifestDurationFormatFloatingPoint is a HlsManifestDurationFormat enum value HlsManifestDurationFormatFloatingPoint = "FLOATING_POINT" // HlsManifestDurationFormatInteger is a HlsManifestDurationFormat enum value HlsManifestDurationFormatInteger = "INTEGER" ) const ( // HlsMediaStoreStorageClassTemporal is a HlsMediaStoreStorageClass enum value HlsMediaStoreStorageClassTemporal = "TEMPORAL" ) const ( // HlsModeLive is a HlsMode enum value HlsModeLive = "LIVE" // HlsModeVod is a HlsMode enum value HlsModeVod = "VOD" ) const ( // HlsOutputSelectionManifestsAndSegments is a HlsOutputSelection enum value HlsOutputSelectionManifestsAndSegments = "MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS" // HlsOutputSelectionSegmentsOnly is a HlsOutputSelection enum value HlsOutputSelectionSegmentsOnly = "SEGMENTS_ONLY" ) const ( // HlsProgramDateTimeExclude is a HlsProgramDateTime enum value HlsProgramDateTimeExclude = "EXCLUDE" // HlsProgramDateTimeInclude is a HlsProgramDateTime enum value HlsProgramDateTimeInclude = "INCLUDE" ) const ( // HlsRedundantManifestDisabled is a HlsRedundantManifest enum value HlsRedundantManifestDisabled = "DISABLED" // HlsRedundantManifestEnabled is a HlsRedundantManifest enum value HlsRedundantManifestEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // HlsSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation is a HlsSegmentationMode enum value HlsSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION" // HlsSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration is a HlsSegmentationMode enum value HlsSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION" ) const ( // HlsStreamInfResolutionExclude is a HlsStreamInfResolution enum value HlsStreamInfResolutionExclude = "EXCLUDE" // HlsStreamInfResolutionInclude is a HlsStreamInfResolution enum value HlsStreamInfResolutionInclude = "INCLUDE" ) const ( // HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameNone is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameNone = "NONE" // HlsTimedMetadataId3FramePriv is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value HlsTimedMetadataId3FramePriv = "PRIV" // HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl = "TDRL" ) const ( // HlsTsFileModeSegmentedFiles is a HlsTsFileMode enum value HlsTsFileModeSegmentedFiles = "SEGMENTED_FILES" // HlsTsFileModeSingleFile is a HlsTsFileMode enum value HlsTsFileModeSingleFile = "SINGLE_FILE" ) const ( // HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeChunked is a HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode enum value HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeChunked = "CHUNKED" // HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeNonChunked is a HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode enum value HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeNonChunked = "NON_CHUNKED" ) // When set to "standard", an I-Frame only playlist will be written out for // each video output in the output group. This I-Frame only playlist will contain // byte range offsets pointing to the I-frame(s) in each segment. const ( // IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeDisabled is a IFrameOnlyPlaylistType enum value IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeDisabled = "DISABLED" // IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeStandard is a IFrameOnlyPlaylistType enum value IFrameOnlyPlaylistTypeStandard = "STANDARD" ) // codec in increasing order of complexity const ( // InputCodecMpeg2 is a InputCodec enum value InputCodecMpeg2 = "MPEG2" // InputCodecAvc is a InputCodec enum value InputCodecAvc = "AVC" // InputCodecHevc is a InputCodec enum value InputCodecHevc = "HEVC" ) const ( // InputDeblockFilterDisabled is a InputDeblockFilter enum value InputDeblockFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // InputDeblockFilterEnabled is a InputDeblockFilter enum value InputDeblockFilterEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // InputDenoiseFilterDisabled is a InputDenoiseFilter enum value InputDenoiseFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // InputDenoiseFilterEnabled is a InputDenoiseFilter enum value InputDenoiseFilterEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // InputFilterAuto is a InputFilter enum value InputFilterAuto = "AUTO" // InputFilterDisabled is a InputFilter enum value InputFilterDisabled = "DISABLED" // InputFilterForced is a InputFilter enum value InputFilterForced = "FORCED" ) const ( // InputLossActionForHlsOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForHlsOut enum value InputLossActionForHlsOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT" // InputLossActionForHlsOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForHlsOut enum value InputLossActionForHlsOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" ) const ( // InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut enum value InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT" // InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut enum value InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" ) const ( // InputLossActionForRtmpOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForRtmpOut enum value InputLossActionForRtmpOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT" // InputLossActionForRtmpOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForRtmpOut enum value InputLossActionForRtmpOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT" ) const ( // InputLossActionForUdpOutDropProgram is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value InputLossActionForUdpOutDropProgram = "DROP_PROGRAM" // InputLossActionForUdpOutDropTs is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value InputLossActionForUdpOutDropTs = "DROP_TS" // InputLossActionForUdpOutEmitProgram is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value InputLossActionForUdpOutEmitProgram = "EMIT_PROGRAM" ) const ( // InputLossImageTypeColor is a InputLossImageType enum value InputLossImageTypeColor = "COLOR" // InputLossImageTypeSlate is a InputLossImageType enum value InputLossImageTypeSlate = "SLATE" ) // Maximum input bitrate in megabits per second. Bitrates up to 50 Mbps are // supported currently. const ( // InputMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value InputMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps = "MAX_10_MBPS" // InputMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value InputMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps = "MAX_20_MBPS" // InputMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value InputMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps = "MAX_50_MBPS" ) // Input resolution based on lines of vertical resolution in the input; SD is // less than 720 lines, HD is 720 to 1080 lines, UHD is greater than 1080 lines const ( // InputResolutionSd is a InputResolution enum value InputResolutionSd = "SD" // InputResolutionHd is a InputResolution enum value InputResolutionHd = "HD" // InputResolutionUhd is a InputResolution enum value InputResolutionUhd = "UHD" ) const ( // InputSecurityGroupStateIdle is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value InputSecurityGroupStateIdle = "IDLE" // InputSecurityGroupStateInUse is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value InputSecurityGroupStateInUse = "IN_USE" // InputSecurityGroupStateUpdating is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value InputSecurityGroupStateUpdating = "UPDATING" // InputSecurityGroupStateDeleted is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value InputSecurityGroupStateDeleted = "DELETED" ) const ( // InputSourceEndBehaviorContinue is a InputSourceEndBehavior enum value InputSourceEndBehaviorContinue = "CONTINUE" // InputSourceEndBehaviorLoop is a InputSourceEndBehavior enum value InputSourceEndBehaviorLoop = "LOOP" ) const ( // InputStateCreating is a InputState enum value InputStateCreating = "CREATING" // InputStateDetached is a InputState enum value InputStateDetached = "DETACHED" // InputStateAttached is a InputState enum value InputStateAttached = "ATTACHED" // InputStateDeleting is a InputState enum value InputStateDeleting = "DELETING" // InputStateDeleted is a InputState enum value InputStateDeleted = "DELETED" ) const ( // InputTypeUdpPush is a InputType enum value InputTypeUdpPush = "UDP_PUSH" // InputTypeRtpPush is a InputType enum value InputTypeRtpPush = "RTP_PUSH" // InputTypeRtmpPush is a InputType enum value InputTypeRtmpPush = "RTMP_PUSH" // InputTypeRtmpPull is a InputType enum value InputTypeRtmpPull = "RTMP_PULL" // InputTypeUrlPull is a InputType enum value InputTypeUrlPull = "URL_PULL" // InputTypeMp4File is a InputType enum value InputTypeMp4File = "MP4_FILE" // InputTypeMediaconnect is a InputType enum value InputTypeMediaconnect = "MEDIACONNECT" ) // The log level the user wants for their channel. const ( // LogLevelError is a LogLevel enum value LogLevelError = "ERROR" // LogLevelWarning is a LogLevel enum value LogLevelWarning = "WARNING" // LogLevelInfo is a LogLevel enum value LogLevelInfo = "INFO" // LogLevelDebug is a LogLevel enum value LogLevelDebug = "DEBUG" // LogLevelDisabled is a LogLevel enum value LogLevelDisabled = "DISABLED" ) const ( // M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorDrop is a M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior enum value M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorDrop = "DROP" // M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorEncodeSilence is a M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior enum value M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorEncodeSilence = "ENCODE_SILENCE" ) const ( // M2tsAribDisabled is a M2tsArib enum value M2tsAribDisabled = "DISABLED" // M2tsAribEnabled is a M2tsArib enum value M2tsAribEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlAuto is a M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl enum value M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlAuto = "AUTO" // M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlUseConfigured is a M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl enum value M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // M2tsAudioBufferModelAtsc is a M2tsAudioBufferModel enum value M2tsAudioBufferModelAtsc = "ATSC" // M2tsAudioBufferModelDvb is a M2tsAudioBufferModel enum value M2tsAudioBufferModelDvb = "DVB" ) const ( // M2tsAudioIntervalVideoAndFixedIntervals is a M2tsAudioInterval enum value M2tsAudioIntervalVideoAndFixedIntervals = "VIDEO_AND_FIXED_INTERVALS" // M2tsAudioIntervalVideoInterval is a M2tsAudioInterval enum value M2tsAudioIntervalVideoInterval = "VIDEO_INTERVAL" ) const ( // M2tsAudioStreamTypeAtsc is a M2tsAudioStreamType enum value M2tsAudioStreamTypeAtsc = "ATSC" // M2tsAudioStreamTypeDvb is a M2tsAudioStreamType enum value M2tsAudioStreamTypeDvb = "DVB" ) const ( // M2tsBufferModelMultiplex is a M2tsBufferModel enum value M2tsBufferModelMultiplex = "MULTIPLEX" // M2tsBufferModelNone is a M2tsBufferModel enum value M2tsBufferModelNone = "NONE" ) const ( // M2tsCcDescriptorDisabled is a M2tsCcDescriptor enum value M2tsCcDescriptorDisabled = "DISABLED" // M2tsCcDescriptorEnabled is a M2tsCcDescriptor enum value M2tsCcDescriptorEnabled = "ENABLED" ) const ( // M2tsEbifControlNone is a M2tsEbifControl enum value M2tsEbifControlNone = "NONE" // M2tsEbifControlPassthrough is a M2tsEbifControl enum value M2tsEbifControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // M2tsEbpPlacementVideoAndAudioPids is a M2tsEbpPlacement enum value M2tsEbpPlacementVideoAndAudioPids = "VIDEO_AND_AUDIO_PIDS" // M2tsEbpPlacementVideoPid is a M2tsEbpPlacement enum value M2tsEbpPlacementVideoPid = "VIDEO_PID" ) const ( // M2tsEsRateInPesExclude is a M2tsEsRateInPes enum value M2tsEsRateInPesExclude = "EXCLUDE" // M2tsEsRateInPesInclude is a M2tsEsRateInPes enum value M2tsEsRateInPesInclude = "INCLUDE" ) const ( // M2tsKlvNone is a M2tsKlv enum value M2tsKlvNone = "NONE" // M2tsKlvPassthrough is a M2tsKlv enum value M2tsKlvPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // M2tsPcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod is a M2tsPcrControl enum value M2tsPcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD" // M2tsPcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket is a M2tsPcrControl enum value M2tsPcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET" ) const ( // M2tsRateModeCbr is a M2tsRateMode enum value M2tsRateModeCbr = "CBR" // M2tsRateModeVbr is a M2tsRateMode enum value M2tsRateModeVbr = "VBR" ) const ( // M2tsScte35ControlNone is a M2tsScte35Control enum value M2tsScte35ControlNone = "NONE" // M2tsScte35ControlPassthrough is a M2tsScte35Control enum value M2tsScte35ControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbp is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbp = "EBP" // M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbpLegacy is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbpLegacy = "EBP_LEGACY" // M2tsSegmentationMarkersNone is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersNone = "NONE" // M2tsSegmentationMarkersPsiSegstart is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersPsiSegstart = "PSI_SEGSTART" // M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiAdapt is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiAdapt = "RAI_ADAPT" // M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiSegstart is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiSegstart = "RAI_SEGSTART" ) const ( // M2tsSegmentationStyleMaintainCadence is a M2tsSegmentationStyle enum value M2tsSegmentationStyleMaintainCadence = "MAINTAIN_CADENCE" // M2tsSegmentationStyleResetCadence is a M2tsSegmentationStyle enum value M2tsSegmentationStyleResetCadence = "RESET_CADENCE" ) const ( // M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough is a M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior enum value M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" // M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough is a M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior enum value M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // M3u8PcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod is a M3u8PcrControl enum value M3u8PcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD" // M3u8PcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket is a M3u8PcrControl enum value M3u8PcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET" ) const ( // M3u8Scte35BehaviorNoPassthrough is a M3u8Scte35Behavior enum value M3u8Scte35BehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" // M3u8Scte35BehaviorPassthrough is a M3u8Scte35Behavior enum value M3u8Scte35BehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough is a M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior enum value M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH" // M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough is a M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior enum value M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" ) const ( // Mp2CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Mp2CodingMode enum value Mp2CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0" // Mp2CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Mp2CodingMode enum value Mp2CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0" ) const ( // NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyAndValidateName is a NetworkInputServerValidation enum value NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyAndValidateName = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_AND_VALIDATE_NAME" // NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyOnly is a NetworkInputServerValidation enum value NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyOnly = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_ONLY" ) // Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS' const ( // OfferingDurationUnitsMonths is a OfferingDurationUnits enum value OfferingDurationUnitsMonths = "MONTHS" ) // Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT' const ( // OfferingTypeNoUpfront is a OfferingType enum value OfferingTypeNoUpfront = "NO_UPFRONT" ) // Codec, 'MPEG2', 'AVC', 'HEVC', or 'AUDIO' const ( // ReservationCodecMpeg2 is a ReservationCodec enum value ReservationCodecMpeg2 = "MPEG2" // ReservationCodecAvc is a ReservationCodec enum value ReservationCodecAvc = "AVC" // ReservationCodecHevc is a ReservationCodec enum value ReservationCodecHevc = "HEVC" // ReservationCodecAudio is a ReservationCodec enum value ReservationCodecAudio = "AUDIO" ) // Maximum bitrate in megabits per second const ( // ReservationMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value ReservationMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps = "MAX_10_MBPS" // ReservationMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value ReservationMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps = "MAX_20_MBPS" // ReservationMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value ReservationMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps = "MAX_50_MBPS" ) // Maximum framerate in frames per second (Outputs only) const ( // ReservationMaximumFramerateMax30Fps is a ReservationMaximumFramerate enum value ReservationMaximumFramerateMax30Fps = "MAX_30_FPS" // ReservationMaximumFramerateMax60Fps is a ReservationMaximumFramerate enum value ReservationMaximumFramerateMax60Fps = "MAX_60_FPS" ) // Resolution based on lines of vertical resolution; SD is less than 720 lines, // HD is 720 to 1080 lines, UHD is greater than 1080 lines const ( // ReservationResolutionSd is a ReservationResolution enum value ReservationResolutionSd = "SD" // ReservationResolutionHd is a ReservationResolution enum value ReservationResolutionHd = "HD" // ReservationResolutionUhd is a ReservationResolution enum value ReservationResolutionUhd = "UHD" ) // Resource type, 'INPUT', 'OUTPUT', or 'CHANNEL' const ( // ReservationResourceTypeInput is a ReservationResourceType enum value ReservationResourceTypeInput = "INPUT" // ReservationResourceTypeOutput is a ReservationResourceType enum value ReservationResourceTypeOutput = "OUTPUT" // ReservationResourceTypeChannel is a ReservationResourceType enum value ReservationResourceTypeChannel = "CHANNEL" ) // Special features, 'ADVANCED_AUDIO' or 'AUDIO_NORMALIZATION' const ( // ReservationSpecialFeatureAdvancedAudio is a ReservationSpecialFeature enum value ReservationSpecialFeatureAdvancedAudio = "ADVANCED_AUDIO" // ReservationSpecialFeatureAudioNormalization is a ReservationSpecialFeature enum value ReservationSpecialFeatureAudioNormalization = "AUDIO_NORMALIZATION" ) // Current reservation state const ( // ReservationStateActive is a ReservationState enum value ReservationStateActive = "ACTIVE" // ReservationStateExpired is a ReservationState enum value ReservationStateExpired = "EXPIRED" // ReservationStateCanceled is a ReservationState enum value ReservationStateCanceled = "CANCELED" // ReservationStateDeleted is a ReservationState enum value ReservationStateDeleted = "DELETED" ) // Video quality, e.g. 'STANDARD' (Outputs only) const ( // ReservationVideoQualityStandard is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value ReservationVideoQualityStandard = "STANDARD" // ReservationVideoQualityEnhanced is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value ReservationVideoQualityEnhanced = "ENHANCED" // ReservationVideoQualityPremium is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value ReservationVideoQualityPremium = "PREMIUM" ) const ( // RtmpCacheFullBehaviorDisconnectImmediately is a RtmpCacheFullBehavior enum value RtmpCacheFullBehaviorDisconnectImmediately = "DISCONNECT_IMMEDIATELY" // RtmpCacheFullBehaviorWaitForServer is a RtmpCacheFullBehavior enum value RtmpCacheFullBehaviorWaitForServer = "WAIT_FOR_SERVER" ) const ( // RtmpCaptionDataAll is a RtmpCaptionData enum value RtmpCaptionDataAll = "ALL" // RtmpCaptionDataField1608 is a RtmpCaptionData enum value RtmpCaptionDataField1608 = "FIELD1_608" // RtmpCaptionDataField1AndField2608 is a RtmpCaptionData enum value RtmpCaptionDataField1AndField2608 = "FIELD1_AND_FIELD2_608" ) const ( // RtmpOutputCertificateModeSelfSigned is a RtmpOutputCertificateMode enum value RtmpOutputCertificateModeSelfSigned = "SELF_SIGNED" // RtmpOutputCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity is a RtmpOutputCertificateMode enum value RtmpOutputCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY" ) const ( // Scte20Convert608To708Disabled is a Scte20Convert608To708 enum value Scte20Convert608To708Disabled = "DISABLED" // Scte20Convert608To708Upconvert is a Scte20Convert608To708 enum value Scte20Convert608To708Upconvert = "UPCONVERT" ) const ( // Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow is a Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW" // Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE" ) const ( // Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow is a Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW" // Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE" ) // Corresponds to the archive_allowed parameter. A value of ARCHIVE_NOT_ALLOWED // corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one // of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them. const ( // Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveNotAllowed is a Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag enum value Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveNotAllowed = "ARCHIVE_NOT_ALLOWED" // Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveAllowed is a Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag enum value Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveAllowed = "ARCHIVE_ALLOWED" ) // Corresponds to the device_restrictions parameter in a segmentation_descriptor. // If you include one of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four // of them. const ( // Scte35DeviceRestrictionsNone is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value Scte35DeviceRestrictionsNone = "NONE" // Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup0 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup0 = "RESTRICT_GROUP0" // Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup1 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup1 = "RESTRICT_GROUP1" // Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup2 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup2 = "RESTRICT_GROUP2" ) // Corresponds to the no_regional_blackout_flag parameter. A value of REGIONAL_BLACKOUT // corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one // of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them. const ( // Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagRegionalBlackout is a Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag enum value Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagRegionalBlackout = "REGIONAL_BLACKOUT" // Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagNoRegionalBlackout is a Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag enum value Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagNoRegionalBlackout = "NO_REGIONAL_BLACKOUT" ) // Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_cancel_indicator. SEGMENTATION_EVENT_NOT_CANCELED // corresponds to 0 in the SCTE-35 specification and indicates that this is // an insertion request. SEGMENTATION_EVENT_CANCELED corresponds to 1 in the // SCTE-35 specification and indicates that this is a cancelation request, in // which case complete this field and the existing event ID to cancel. const ( // Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventNotCanceled is a Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator enum value Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventNotCanceled = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_NOT_CANCELED" // Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventCanceled is a Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator enum value Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventCanceled = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_CANCELED" ) const ( // Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow is a Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW" // Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE" ) const ( // Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow is a Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW" // Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE" ) // Corresponds to the web_delivery_allowed_flag parameter. A value of WEB_DELIVERY_NOT_ALLOWED // corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one // of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them. const ( // Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryNotAllowed is a Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag enum value Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryNotAllowed = "WEB_DELIVERY_NOT_ALLOWED" // Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryAllowed is a Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag enum value Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryAllowed = "WEB_DELIVERY_ALLOWED" ) const ( // SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlPassthrough is a SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl enum value SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" // SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlUseConfiguredClock is a SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl enum value SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlUseConfiguredClock = "USE_CONFIGURED_CLOCK" ) const ( // SmoothGroupCertificateModeSelfSigned is a SmoothGroupCertificateMode enum value SmoothGroupCertificateModeSelfSigned = "SELF_SIGNED" // SmoothGroupCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity is a SmoothGroupCertificateMode enum value SmoothGroupCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY" ) const ( // SmoothGroupEventIdModeNoEventId is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value SmoothGroupEventIdModeNoEventId = "NO_EVENT_ID" // SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseConfigured is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" // SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseTimestamp is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseTimestamp = "USE_TIMESTAMP" ) const ( // SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorNone is a SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior enum value SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorNone = "NONE" // SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorSendEos is a SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior enum value SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorSendEos = "SEND_EOS" ) const ( // SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation is a SmoothGroupSegmentationMode enum value SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION" // SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration is a SmoothGroupSegmentationMode enum value SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION" ) const ( // SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeNone is a SmoothGroupSparseTrackType enum value SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeNone = "NONE" // SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35 is a SmoothGroupSparseTrackType enum value SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35 = "SCTE_35" ) const ( // SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorDoNotSend is a SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior enum value SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorDoNotSend = "DO_NOT_SEND" // SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorSend is a SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior enum value SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorSend = "SEND" ) const ( // SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseConfiguredOffset is a SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode enum value SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseConfiguredOffset = "USE_CONFIGURED_OFFSET" // SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseEventStartDate is a SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode enum value SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseEventStartDate = "USE_EVENT_START_DATE" ) const ( // TimecodeConfigSourceEmbedded is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value TimecodeConfigSourceEmbedded = "EMBEDDED" // TimecodeConfigSourceSystemclock is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value TimecodeConfigSourceSystemclock = "SYSTEMCLOCK" // TimecodeConfigSourceZerobased is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value TimecodeConfigSourceZerobased = "ZEROBASED" ) const ( // TtmlDestinationStyleControlPassthrough is a TtmlDestinationStyleControl enum value TtmlDestinationStyleControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" // TtmlDestinationStyleControlUseConfigured is a TtmlDestinationStyleControl enum value TtmlDestinationStyleControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED" ) const ( // UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameNone is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameNone = "NONE" // UdpTimedMetadataId3FramePriv is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value UdpTimedMetadataId3FramePriv = "PRIV" // UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl = "TDRL" ) const ( // VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdNone is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdNone = "NONE" // VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdPassthrough is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH" // VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdRespond is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdRespond = "RESPOND" ) const ( // VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorDefault is a VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior enum value VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorDefault = "DEFAULT" // VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorStretchToOutput is a VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior enum value VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorStretchToOutput = "STRETCH_TO_OUTPUT" ) const ( // VideoSelectorColorSpaceFollow is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value VideoSelectorColorSpaceFollow = "FOLLOW" // VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec601 is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec601 = "REC_601" // VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec709 is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec709 = "REC_709" ) const ( // VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageFallback is a VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage enum value VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageFallback = "FALLBACK" // VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageForce is a VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage enum value VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageForce = "FORCE" )